10624 lines
		
	
	
		
			356 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C
		
	
	
	
	
	
		
		
			
		
	
	
			10624 lines
		
	
	
		
			356 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			C
		
	
	
	
	
	
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*      Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions       *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                       Written by Philip Hazel
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     Original API code Copyright (c) 1997-2012 University of Cambridge
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          New API code Copyright (c) 2016-2022 University of Cambridge
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    * Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      this software without specific prior written permission.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#include "config.h"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define NLBLOCK cb             /* Block containing newline information */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PSSTART start_pattern  /* Field containing processed string start */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PSEND   end_pattern    /* Field containing processed string end */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#include "pcre2_internal.h"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* In rare error cases debugging might require calling pcre2_printint(). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if 0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PRINTABLE(c) ((c) >= 64 && (c) < 255)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PRINTABLE(c) ((c) >= 32 && (c) < 127)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#include "pcre2_printint.c"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define DEBUG_CALL_PRINTINT
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Other debugging code can be enabled by these defines. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* #define DEBUG_SHOW_CAPTURES */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* #define DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* There are a few things that vary with different code unit sizes. Handle them
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								by defining macros in order to minimize #if usage. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR     STRING_UTF8_RIGHTPAR, 5
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define XDIGIT(c)                xdigitab[c]
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else  /* Either 16-bit or 32-bit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define XDIGIT(c)                (MAX_255(c)? xdigitab[c] : 0xff)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR     STRING_UTF16_RIGHTPAR, 6
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else  /* 32-bit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR     STRING_UTF32_RIGHTPAR, 6
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Macros to store and retrieve a PCRE2_SIZE value in the parsed pattern, which
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								consists of uint32_t elements. Assume that if uint32_t can't hold it, two of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								them will be able to (i.e. assume a 64-bit world). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_SIZE_MAX <= UINT32_MAX
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PUTOFFSET(s,p) *p++ = s
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GETOFFSET(s,p) s = *p++
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GETPLUSOFFSET(s,p) s = *(++p)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define READPLUSOFFSET(s,p) s = p[1]
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define SKIPOFFSET(p) p++
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define SIZEOFFSET 1
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PUTOFFSET(s,p) \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { *p++ = (uint32_t)(s >> 32); *p++ = (uint32_t)(s & 0xffffffff); }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GETOFFSET(s,p) \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[0] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[1]; p += 2; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GETPLUSOFFSET(s,p) \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[1] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[2]; p += 2; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define READPLUSOFFSET(s,p) \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[1] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[2]; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define SKIPOFFSET(p) p += 2
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define SIZEOFFSET 2
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Macros for manipulating elements of the parsed pattern vector. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CODE(x)   (x & 0xffff0000u)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_DATA(x)   (x & 0x0000ffffu)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_DIFF(x,y) ((x-y)>>16)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Function definitions to allow mutual recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  add_list_to_class_internal(uint8_t *, PCRE2_UCHAR **, uint32_t,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    compile_block *, const uint32_t *, unsigned int);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  compile_regex(uint32_t, PCRE2_UCHAR **, uint32_t **, int *, uint32_t,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    uint32_t *, uint32_t *, uint32_t *, uint32_t *, branch_chain *,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    compile_block *, PCRE2_SIZE *);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  get_branchlength(uint32_t **, int *, int *, parsed_recurse_check *,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    compile_block *);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  set_lookbehind_lengths(uint32_t **, int *, int *, parsed_recurse_check *,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    compile_block *);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  check_lookbehinds(uint32_t *, uint32_t **, parsed_recurse_check *,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    compile_block *, int *);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*      Code parameters and static tables         *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define MAX_GROUP_NUMBER   65535u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define MAX_REPEAT_COUNT   65535u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define REPEAT_UNLIMITED   (MAX_REPEAT_COUNT+1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* COMPILE_WORK_SIZE specifies the size of stack workspace, which is used in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								different ways in the different pattern scans. The parsing and group-
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								identifying pre-scan uses it to handle nesting, and needs it to be 16-bit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								aligned for this. Having defined the size in code units, we set up
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								C16_WORK_SIZE as the number of elements in the 16-bit vector.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								During the first compiling phase, when determining how much memory is required,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the regex is partly compiled into this space, but the compiled parts are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								discarded as soon as they can be, so that hopefully there will never be an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								overrun. The code does, however, check for an overrun, which can occur for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pathological patterns. The size of the workspace depends on LINK_SIZE because
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the length of compiled items varies with this.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								In the real compile phase, this workspace is not currently used. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE (3000*LINK_SIZE)   /* Size in code units */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define C16_WORK_SIZE \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ((COMPILE_WORK_SIZE * sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR))/sizeof(uint16_t))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* A uint32_t vector is used for caching information about the size of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								capturing groups, to improve performance. A default is created on the stack of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								this size. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE 256
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The overrun tests check for a slightly smaller size so that they detect the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								overrun before it actually does run off the end of the data block. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN (100)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This value determines the size of the initial vector that is used for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								remembering named groups during the pre-compile. It is allocated on the stack,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								but if it is too small, it is expanded, in a similar way to the workspace. The
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								value is the number of slots in the list. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE  20
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The pre-compiling pass over the pattern creates a parsed pattern in a vector
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								of uint32_t. For short patterns this lives on the stack, with this size. Heap
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memory is used for longer patterns. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE 1024
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Maximum length value to check against when making sure that the variable
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								that holds the compiled pattern length does not overflow. We make it a bit less
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								than INT_MAX to allow for adding in group terminating code units, so that we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								don't have to check them every time. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define OFLOW_MAX (INT_MAX - 20)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Code values for parsed patterns, which are stored in a vector of 32-bit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unsigned ints. Values less than META_END are literal data values. The coding
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for identifying the item is in the top 16-bits, leaving 16 bits for the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								additional data that some of them need. The META_CODE, META_DATA, and META_DIFF
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								macros are used to manipulate parsed pattern elements.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								NOTE: When these definitions are changed, the table of extra lengths for each
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								code (meta_extra_lengths, just below) must be updated to remain in step. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_END              0x80000000u  /* End of pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ALT              0x80010000u  /* alternation */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ATOMIC           0x80020000u  /* atomic group */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_BACKREF          0x80030000u  /* Back ref */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_BACKREF_BYNAME   0x80040000u  /* \k'name' */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_BIGVALUE         0x80050000u  /* Next is a literal > META_END */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CALLOUT_NUMBER   0x80060000u  /* (?C with numerical argument */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CALLOUT_STRING   0x80070000u  /* (?C with string argument */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CAPTURE          0x80080000u  /* Capturing parenthesis */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CIRCUMFLEX       0x80090000u  /* ^ metacharacter */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CLASS            0x800a0000u  /* start non-empty class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CLASS_EMPTY      0x800b0000u  /* empty class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT  0x800c0000u  /* negative empty class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CLASS_END        0x800d0000u  /* end of non-empty class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_CLASS_NOT        0x800e0000u  /* start non-empty negative class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COND_ASSERT      0x800f0000u  /* (?(?assertion)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COND_DEFINE      0x80100000u  /* (?(DEFINE)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COND_NAME        0x80110000u  /* (?(<name>)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COND_NUMBER      0x80120000u  /* (?(digits)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COND_RNAME       0x80130000u  /* (?(R&name)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COND_RNUMBER     0x80140000u  /* (?(Rdigits)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COND_VERSION     0x80150000u  /* (?(VERSION<op>x.y)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_DOLLAR           0x80160000u  /* $ metacharacter */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_DOT              0x80170000u  /* . metacharacter */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ESCAPE           0x80180000u  /* \d and friends */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_KET              0x80190000u  /* closing parenthesis */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_NOCAPTURE        0x801a0000u  /* no capture parens */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_OPTIONS          0x801b0000u  /* (?i) and friends */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_POSIX            0x801c0000u  /* POSIX class item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_POSIX_NEG        0x801d0000u  /* negative POSIX class item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_RANGE_ESCAPED    0x801e0000u  /* range with at least one escape */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_RANGE_LITERAL    0x801f0000u  /* range defined literally */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_RECURSE          0x80200000u  /* Recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_RECURSE_BYNAME   0x80210000u  /* (?&name) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_SCRIPT_RUN       0x80220000u  /* (*script_run:...) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* These must be kept together to make it easy to check that an assertion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is present where expected in a conditional group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_LOOKAHEAD        0x80230000u  /* (?= */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_LOOKAHEADNOT     0x80240000u  /* (?! */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_LOOKBEHIND       0x80250000u  /* (?<= */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_LOOKBEHINDNOT    0x80260000u  /* (?<! */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* These cannot be conditions */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_LOOKAHEAD_NA     0x80270000u  /* (*napla: */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_LOOKBEHIND_NA    0x80280000u  /* (*naplb: */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* These must be kept in this order, with consecutive values, and the _ARG
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								versions of COMMIT, PRUNE, SKIP, and THEN immediately after their non-argument
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								versions. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_MARK             0x80290000u  /* (*MARK) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ACCEPT           0x802a0000u  /* (*ACCEPT) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_FAIL             0x802b0000u  /* (*FAIL) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COMMIT           0x802c0000u  /* These               */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_COMMIT_ARG       0x802d0000u  /*   pairs             */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_PRUNE            0x802e0000u  /*     must            */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_PRUNE_ARG        0x802f0000u  /*       be            */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_SKIP             0x80300000u  /*         kept        */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_SKIP_ARG         0x80310000u  /*           in        */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_THEN             0x80320000u  /*             this    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_THEN_ARG         0x80330000u  /*               order */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* These must be kept in groups of adjacent 3 values, and all together. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ASTERISK         0x80340000u  /* *  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ASTERISK_PLUS    0x80350000u  /* *+ */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ASTERISK_QUERY   0x80360000u  /* *? */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_PLUS             0x80370000u  /* +  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_PLUS_PLUS        0x80380000u  /* ++ */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_PLUS_QUERY       0x80390000u  /* +? */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_QUERY            0x803a0000u  /* ?  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_QUERY_PLUS       0x803b0000u  /* ?+ */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_QUERY_QUERY      0x803c0000u  /* ?? */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_MINMAX           0x803d0000u  /* {n,m}  repeat */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_MINMAX_PLUS      0x803e0000u  /* {n,m}+ repeat */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_MINMAX_QUERY     0x803f0000u  /* {n,m}? repeat */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_FIRST_QUANTIFIER META_ASTERISK
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_LAST_QUANTIFIER  META_MINMAX_QUERY
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is a special "meta code" that is used only to distinguish (*asr: from
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								(*sr: in the table of aphabetic assertions. It is never stored in the parsed
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pattern because (*asr: is turned into (*sr:(*atomic: at that stage. There is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								therefore no need for it to have a length entry, so use a high value. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN 0x8fff0000u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Table of extra lengths for each of the meta codes. Must be kept in step with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the definitions above. For some items these values are a basic length to which
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								a variable amount has to be added. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned char meta_extra_lengths[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_END */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_ALT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_ATOMIC */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_BACKREF - more if group is >= 10 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1+SIZEOFFSET,  /* META_BACKREF_BYNAME */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_BIGVALUE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  3,             /* META_CALLOUT_NUMBER */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  3+SIZEOFFSET,  /* META_CALLOUT_STRING */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_CAPTURE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_CIRCUMFLEX */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_CLASS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_CLASS_EMPTY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_CLASS_END */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_CLASS_NOT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_COND_ASSERT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  SIZEOFFSET,    /* META_COND_DEFINE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1+SIZEOFFSET,  /* META_COND_NAME */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1+SIZEOFFSET,  /* META_COND_NUMBER */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1+SIZEOFFSET,  /* META_COND_RNAME */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1+SIZEOFFSET,  /* META_COND_RNUMBER */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  3,             /* META_COND_VERSION */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_DOLLAR */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_DOT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_ESCAPE - more for ESC_P, ESC_p, ESC_g, ESC_k */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_KET */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_NOCAPTURE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_OPTIONS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_POSIX */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_POSIX_NEG */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_RANGE_ESCAPED */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_RANGE_LITERAL */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  SIZEOFFSET,    /* META_RECURSE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1+SIZEOFFSET,  /* META_RECURSE_BYNAME */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_SCRIPT_RUN */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_LOOKAHEAD */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_LOOKAHEADNOT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  SIZEOFFSET,    /* META_LOOKBEHIND */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  SIZEOFFSET,    /* META_LOOKBEHINDNOT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_LOOKAHEAD_NA */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  SIZEOFFSET,    /* META_LOOKBEHIND_NA */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_MARK - plus the string length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_ACCEPT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_FAIL */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_COMMIT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_COMMIT_ARG - plus the string length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_PRUNE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_PRUNE_ARG - plus the string length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_SKIP */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_SKIP_ARG - plus the string length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_THEN */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  1,             /* META_THEN_ARG - plus the string length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_ASTERISK */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_ASTERISK_PLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_ASTERISK_QUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_PLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_PLUS_PLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_PLUS_QUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_QUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_QUERY_PLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,             /* META_QUERY_QUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  2,             /* META_MINMAX */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  2,             /* META_MINMAX_PLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  2              /* META_MINMAX_QUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Types for skipping parts of a parsed pattern. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								enum { PSKIP_ALT, PSKIP_CLASS, PSKIP_KET };
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Macro for setting individual bits in class bitmaps. It took some
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								experimenting to figure out how to stop gcc 5.3.0 from warning with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								-Wconversion. This version gets a warning:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  #define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] |= (uint8_t)(1u << ((b)&7))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Let's hope the apparently less efficient version isn't actually so bad if the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compiler is clever with identical subexpressions. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] = (uint8_t)(a[(b)/8] | (1u << ((b)&7)))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Values and flags for the unsigned xxcuflags variables that accompany xxcu
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								variables, which are concerned with first and required code units. A value
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								greater than or equal to REQ_NONE means "no code unit set"; otherwise the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								matching xxcu variable is set, and the low valued bits are relevant. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define REQ_UNSET     0xffffffffu  /* Not yet found anything */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define REQ_NONE      0xfffffffeu  /* Found not fixed character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define REQ_CASELESS  0x00000001u  /* Code unit in xxcu is caseless */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define REQ_VARY      0x00000002u  /* Code unit is followed by non-literal */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* These flags are used in the groupinfo vector. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH    0x80000000u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH    0x40000000u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define GI_FIXED_LENGTH_MASK   0x0000ffffu
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This simple test for a decimal digit works for both ASCII/Unicode and EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								and is fast (a good compiler can turn it into a subtraction and unsigned
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								comparison). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define IS_DIGIT(x) ((x) >= CHAR_0 && (x) <= CHAR_9)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Table to identify hex digits. The tables in chartables are dependent on the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								locale, and may mark arbitrary characters as digits. We want to recognize only
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								0-9, a-z, and A-Z as hex digits, which is why we have a private table here. It
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								costs 256 bytes, but it is a lot faster than doing character value tests (at
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								least in some simple cases I timed), and in some applications one wants PCRE2
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								to compile efficiently as well as match efficiently. The value in the table is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the binary hex digit value, or 0xff for non-hex digits. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is the "normal" case, for ASCII systems, and EBCDIC systems running in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								UTF-8 mode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifndef EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const uint8_t xdigitab[] =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*   0-  7 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*   8- 15 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  16- 23 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  24- 31 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*    - '  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  ( - /  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0x00,0x01,0x02,0x03,0x04,0x05,0x06,0x07, /*  0 - 7  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0x08,0x09,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  8 - ?  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /*  @ - G  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  H - O  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  P - W  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  X - _  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /*  ` - g  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  h - o  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  p - w  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  x -127 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 128-135 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 136-143 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 144-151 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 152-159 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 160-167 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 168-175 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 176-183 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 184-191 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 192-199 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 2ff-207 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 208-215 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 216-223 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 224-231 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 232-239 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 240-247 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff};/* 248-255 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is the "abnormal" case, for EBCDIC systems not running in UTF-8 mode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const uint8_t xdigitab[] =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*   0-  7  0 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*   8- 15    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  16- 23 10 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  24- 31    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  32- 39 20 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  40- 47    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  48- 55 30 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  56- 63    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*    - 71 40 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  72- |     */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  & - 87 50 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  88- 95    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  - -103 60 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 104- ?     */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 112-119 70 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 120- "     */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* 128- g  80 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  h -143    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 144- p  90 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  q -159    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 160- x  A0 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  y -175    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  ^ -183 B0 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 184-191    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /*  { - G  C0 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  H -207    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  } - P  D0 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  Q -223    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  \ - X  E0 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /*  Y -239    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0x00,0x01,0x02,0x03,0x04,0x05,0x06,0x07, /*  0 - 7  F0 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0x08,0x09,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff};/*  8 -255    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* EBCDIC */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Table for handling alphanumeric escaped characters. Positive returns are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								simple data values; negative values are for special things like \d and so on.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Zero means further processing is needed (for things like \x), or the escape is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								invalid. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is the "normal" table for ASCII systems or for EBCDIC systems running
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								in UTF-8 mode. It runs from '0' to 'z'. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifndef EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define ESCAPES_FIRST       CHAR_0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define ESCAPES_LAST        CHAR_z
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define UPPER_CASE(c)       (c-32)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const short int escapes[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_COLON,              CHAR_SEMICOLON,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN,     CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN,  CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_COMMERCIAL_AT,      -ESC_A,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_B,                  -ESC_C,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_D,                  -ESC_E,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       -ESC_G,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_H,                  0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       -ESC_K,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_N,                  0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_P,                  -ESC_Q,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_R,                  -ESC_S,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_V,                  -ESC_W,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_X,                  0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_Z,                  CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_BACKSLASH,          CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT,  CHAR_UNDERSCORE,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_GRAVE_ACCENT,       CHAR_BEL,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_b,                  0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_d,                  CHAR_ESC,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_FF,                 0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_h,                  0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       -ESC_k,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_LF,                 0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_p,                  0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_CR,                 -ESC_s,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     CHAR_HT,                 0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_v,                  -ESC_w,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     0,                       0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     -ESC_z
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is the "abnormal" table for EBCDIC systems without UTF-8 support.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								It runs from 'a' to '9'. For some minimal testing of EBCDIC features, the code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is sometimes compiled on an ASCII system. In this case, we must not use CHAR_a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								because it is defined as 'a', which of course picks up the ASCII value. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if 'a' == 0x81                    /* Check for a real EBCDIC environment */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define ESCAPES_FIRST       CHAR_a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define ESCAPES_LAST        CHAR_9
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define UPPER_CASE(c)       (c+64)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else                              /* Testing in an ASCII environment */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define ESCAPES_FIRST  ((unsigned char)'\x81')   /* EBCDIC 'a' */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define ESCAPES_LAST   ((unsigned char)'\xf9')   /* EBCDIC '9' */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define UPPER_CASE(c)  (c-32)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const short int escapes[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  80 */         CHAR_BEL, -ESC_b,       0, -ESC_d, CHAR_ESC, CHAR_FF,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  88 */ -ESC_h,        0,      0,     '{',      0,        0,       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  90 */      0,        0, -ESC_k,       0,      0,  CHAR_LF,       0, -ESC_p,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  98 */      0,  CHAR_CR,      0,     '}',      0,        0,       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  A0 */      0,      '~', -ESC_s, CHAR_HT,      0,   -ESC_v,  -ESC_w,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  A8 */      0,   -ESC_z,      0,       0,      0,      '[',       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  B0 */      0,        0,      0,       0,      0,        0,       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  B8 */      0,        0,      0,       0,      0,      ']',     '=',    '-',
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  C0 */    '{',   -ESC_A, -ESC_B,  -ESC_C, -ESC_D,   -ESC_E,       0, -ESC_G,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  C8 */ -ESC_H,        0,      0,       0,      0,        0,       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  D0 */    '}',        0, -ESC_K,       0,      0,   -ESC_N,       0, -ESC_P,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  D8 */ -ESC_Q,   -ESC_R,      0,       0,      0,        0,       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  E0 */   '\\',        0, -ESC_S,       0,      0,   -ESC_V,  -ESC_W, -ESC_X,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  E8 */      0,   -ESC_Z,      0,       0,      0,        0,       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  F0 */      0,        0,      0,       0,      0,        0,       0,      0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*  F8 */      0,        0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* We also need a table of characters that may follow \c in an EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								environment for characters 0-31. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned char ebcdic_escape_c[] = "@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\\]^_";
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif   /* EBCDIC */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Table of special "verbs" like (*PRUNE). This is a short table, so it is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								searched linearly. Put all the names into a single string, in order to reduce
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the number of relocations when a shared library is dynamically linked. The
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								string is built from string macros so that it works in UTF-8 mode on EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								platforms. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								typedef struct verbitem {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  unsigned int len;          /* Length of verb name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t meta;             /* Base META_ code */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int has_arg;               /* Argument requirement */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								} verbitem;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const char verbnames[] =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  "\0"                       /* Empty name is a shorthand for MARK */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_MARK0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_ACCEPT0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_F0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_FAIL0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_COMMIT0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_PRUNE0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_SKIP0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_THEN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const verbitem verbs[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 0, META_MARK,   +1 },  /* > 0 => must have an argument */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 4, META_MARK,   +1 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 6, META_ACCEPT, -1 },  /* < 0 => Optional argument, convert to pre-MARK */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 1, META_FAIL,   -1 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 4, META_FAIL,   -1 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 6, META_COMMIT,  0 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 5, META_PRUNE,   0 },  /* Optional argument; bump META code if found */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 4, META_SKIP,    0 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 4, META_THEN,    0 }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const int verbcount = sizeof(verbs)/sizeof(verbitem);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Verb opcodes, indexed by their META code offset from META_MARK. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const uint32_t verbops[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_MARK, OP_ACCEPT, OP_FAIL, OP_COMMIT, OP_COMMIT_ARG, OP_PRUNE,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_PRUNE_ARG, OP_SKIP, OP_SKIP_ARG, OP_THEN, OP_THEN_ARG };
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Table of "alpha assertions" like (*pla:...), similar to the (*VERB) table. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								typedef struct alasitem {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  unsigned int len;          /* Length of name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t meta;             /* Base META_ code */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								} alasitem;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const char alasnames[] =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_pla0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_plb0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_napla0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_naplb0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_nla0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_nlb0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_positive_lookahead0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_positive_lookbehind0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_non_atomic_positive_lookahead0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_non_atomic_positive_lookbehind0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_negative_lookahead0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_negative_lookbehind0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_atomic0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_sr0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_asr0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_script_run0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_atomic_script_run;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const alasitem alasmeta[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  3, META_LOOKAHEAD         },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  3, META_LOOKBEHIND        },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  5, META_LOOKAHEAD_NA      },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  5, META_LOOKBEHIND_NA     },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  3, META_LOOKAHEADNOT      },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  3, META_LOOKBEHINDNOT     },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 18, META_LOOKAHEAD         },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 19, META_LOOKBEHIND        },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 29, META_LOOKAHEAD_NA      },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 30, META_LOOKBEHIND_NA     },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 18, META_LOOKAHEADNOT      },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 19, META_LOOKBEHINDNOT     },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  6, META_ATOMIC            },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  2, META_SCRIPT_RUN        }, /* sr = script run */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {  3, META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN }, /* asr = atomic script run */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 10, META_SCRIPT_RUN        }, /* script run */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { 17, META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN }  /* atomic script run */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const int alascount = sizeof(alasmeta)/sizeof(alasitem);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Offsets from OP_STAR for case-independent and negative repeat opcodes. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static uint32_t chartypeoffset[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_STAR - OP_STAR,    OP_STARI - OP_STAR,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTSTAR - OP_STAR, OP_NOTSTARI - OP_STAR };
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Tables of names of POSIX character classes and their lengths. The names are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								now all in a single string, to reduce the number of relocations when a shared
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								library is dynamically loaded. The list of lengths is terminated by a zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length entry. The first three must be alpha, lower, upper, as this is assumed
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for handling case independence. The indices for graph, print, and punct are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								needed, so identify them. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const char posix_names[] =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_alpha0 STRING_lower0 STRING_upper0 STRING_alnum0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_ascii0 STRING_blank0 STRING_cntrl0 STRING_digit0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_graph0 STRING_print0 STRING_punct0 STRING_space0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  STRING_word0  STRING_xdigit;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const uint8_t posix_name_lengths[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 4, 6, 0 };
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PC_GRAPH  8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PC_PRINT  9
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PC_PUNCT 10
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Table of class bit maps for each POSIX class. Each class is formed from a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								base map, with an optional addition or removal of another map. Then, for some
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								classes, there is some additional tweaking: for [:blank:] the vertical space
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								characters are removed, and for [:alpha:] and [:alnum:] the underscore
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								character is removed. The triples in the table consist of the base map offset,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								second map offset or -1 if no second map, and a non-negative value for map
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								addition or a negative value for map subtraction (if there are two maps). The
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								absolute value of the third field has these meanings: 0 => no tweaking, 1 =>
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								remove vertical space characters, 2 => remove underscore. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const int posix_class_maps[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_word,  cbit_digit, -2,             /* alpha */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_lower, -1,          0,             /* lower */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_upper, -1,          0,             /* upper */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_word,  -1,          2,             /* alnum - word without underscore */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_print, cbit_cntrl,  0,             /* ascii */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_space, -1,          1,             /* blank - a GNU extension */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_cntrl, -1,          0,             /* cntrl */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_digit, -1,          0,             /* digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_graph, -1,          0,             /* graph */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_print, -1,          0,             /* print */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_punct, -1,          0,             /* punct */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_space, -1,          0,             /* space */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_word,  -1,          0,             /* word - a Perl extension */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cbit_xdigit,-1,          0              /* xdigit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The POSIX class Unicode property substitutes that are used in UCP mode must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								be in the order of the POSIX class names, defined above. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int posix_substitutes[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_GC, ucp_L,     /* alpha */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PC, ucp_Ll,    /* lower */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PC, ucp_Lu,    /* upper */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_ALNUM, 0,      /* alnum */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  -1, 0,            /* ascii, treat as non-UCP */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  -1, 1,            /* blank, treat as \h */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PC, ucp_Cc,    /* cntrl */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PC, ucp_Nd,    /* digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PXGRAPH, 0,    /* graph */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PXPRINT, 0,    /* print */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PXPUNCT, 0,    /* punct */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_PXSPACE, 0,    /* space */   /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PT_WORD, 0,       /* word  */   /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  -1, 0             /* xdigit, treat as non-UCP */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define POSIX_SUBSIZE (sizeof(posix_substitutes) / (2*sizeof(uint32_t)))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Masks for checking option settings. When PCRE2_LITERAL is set, only a subset
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								are allowed. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  (PCRE2_ANCHORED|PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT|PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_ENDANCHORED| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_FIRSTLINE|PCRE2_LITERAL|PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE|PCRE2_NO_UTF_CHECK|PCRE2_USE_OFFSET_LIMIT|PCRE2_UTF)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  (PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS|PCRE2_ALT_BSUX|PCRE2_ALT_CIRCUMFLEX| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES|PCRE2_DOLLAR_ENDONLY|PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_DUPNAMES| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE|PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NEVER_BACKSLASH_C|PCRE2_NEVER_UCP| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_NEVER_UTF|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR|PCRE2_UCP|PCRE2_UNGREEDY)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   (PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE|PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PUBLIC_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   (PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES|PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PCRE2_EXTRA_ESCAPED_CR_IS_LF|PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_LOOKAROUND_BSK)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Compile time error code numbers. They are given names so that they can more
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								easily be tracked. When a new number is added, the tables called eint1 and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								eint2 in pcre2posix.c may need to be updated, and a new error text must be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								added to compile_error_texts in pcre2_error.c. Also, the error codes in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2.h.in must be updated - their values are exactly 100 greater than these
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								values. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								enum { ERR0 = COMPILE_ERROR_BASE,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR1,  ERR2,  ERR3,  ERR4,  ERR5,  ERR6,  ERR7,  ERR8,  ERR9,  ERR10,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR11, ERR12, ERR13, ERR14, ERR15, ERR16, ERR17, ERR18, ERR19, ERR20,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR21, ERR22, ERR23, ERR24, ERR25, ERR26, ERR27, ERR28, ERR29, ERR30,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR31, ERR32, ERR33, ERR34, ERR35, ERR36, ERR37, ERR38, ERR39, ERR40,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR41, ERR42, ERR43, ERR44, ERR45, ERR46, ERR47, ERR48, ERR49, ERR50,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR51, ERR52, ERR53, ERR54, ERR55, ERR56, ERR57, ERR58, ERR59, ERR60,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR61, ERR62, ERR63, ERR64, ERR65, ERR66, ERR67, ERR68, ERR69, ERR70,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR71, ERR72, ERR73, ERR74, ERR75, ERR76, ERR77, ERR78, ERR79, ERR80,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR81, ERR82, ERR83, ERR84, ERR85, ERR86, ERR87, ERR88, ERR89, ERR90,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ERR91, ERR92, ERR93, ERR94, ERR95, ERR96, ERR97, ERR98, ERR99 };
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is a table of start-of-pattern options such as (*UTF) and settings such
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								as (*LIMIT_MATCH=nnnn) and (*CRLF). For completeness and backward
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compatibility, (*UTFn) is supported in the relevant libraries, but (*UTF) is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								generic and always supported. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								enum { PSO_OPT,     /* Value is an option bit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       PSO_FLG,     /* Value is a flag bit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       PSO_NL,      /* Value is a newline type */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       PSO_BSR,     /* Value is a \R type */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       PSO_LIMH,    /* Read integer value for heap limit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       PSO_LIMM,    /* Read integer value for match limit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       PSO_LIMD };  /* Read integer value for depth limit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								typedef struct pso {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  const uint8_t *name;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint16_t length;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint16_t type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								} pso;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* NB: STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR contains the length as well */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static pso pso_list[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR,                  PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UTF },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_UTF_RIGHTPAR,                4, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UTF },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_UCP_RIGHTPAR,                4, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UCP },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_NOTEMPTY_RIGHTPAR,           9, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NOTEMPTY_SET },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_NOTEMPTY_ATSTART_RIGHTPAR,  17, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NE_ATST_SET },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_AUTO_POSSESS_RIGHTPAR,   16, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR_RIGHTPAR, 18, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_JIT_RIGHTPAR,             7, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NOJIT },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_START_OPT_RIGHTPAR,      13, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_HEAP_EQ,              11, PSO_LIMH, 0 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_MATCH_EQ,             12, PSO_LIMM, 0 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_DEPTH_EQ,             12, PSO_LIMD, 0 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_RECURSION_EQ,         16, PSO_LIMD, 0 },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_CR_RIGHTPAR,                 3, PSO_NL,  PCRE2_NEWLINE_CR },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_LF_RIGHTPAR,                 3, PSO_NL,  PCRE2_NEWLINE_LF },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_CRLF_RIGHTPAR,               5, PSO_NL,  PCRE2_NEWLINE_CRLF },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_ANY_RIGHTPAR,                4, PSO_NL,  PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANY },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_NUL_RIGHTPAR,                4, PSO_NL,  PCRE2_NEWLINE_NUL },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR,            8, PSO_NL,  PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_BSR_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR,       12, PSO_BSR, PCRE2_BSR_ANYCRLF },
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { (uint8_t *)STRING_BSR_UNICODE_RIGHTPAR,       12, PSO_BSR, PCRE2_BSR_UNICODE }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This table is used when converting repeating opcodes into possessified
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								versions as a result of an explicit possessive quantifier such as ++. A zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								value means there is no possessified version - in those cases the item in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								question must be wrapped in ONCE brackets. The table is truncated at OP_CALLOUT
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								because all relevant opcodes are less than that. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const uint8_t opcode_possessify[] = {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 0 - 15  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 16 - 31 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,                       /* NOTI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSSTAR, 0,           /* STAR, MINSTAR */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSPLUS, 0,           /* PLUS, MINPLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSQUERY, 0,          /* QUERY, MINQUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSUPTO, 0,           /* UPTO, MINUPTO */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,                       /* EXACT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSSTARI, 0,          /* STARI, MINSTARI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSPLUSI, 0,          /* PLUSI, MINPLUSI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSQUERYI, 0,         /* QUERYI, MINQUERYI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_POSUPTOI, 0,          /* UPTOI, MINUPTOI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,                       /* EXACTI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSSTAR, 0,        /* NOTSTAR, NOTMINSTAR */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSPLUS, 0,        /* NOTPLUS, NOTMINPLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSQUERY, 0,       /* NOTQUERY, NOTMINQUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSUPTO, 0,        /* NOTUPTO, NOTMINUPTO */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,                       /* NOTEXACT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSSTARI, 0,       /* NOTSTARI, NOTMINSTARI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSPLUSI, 0,       /* NOTPLUSI, NOTMINPLUSI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSQUERYI, 0,      /* NOTQUERYI, NOTMINQUERYI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_NOTPOSUPTOI, 0,       /* NOTUPTOI, NOTMINUPTOI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,                       /* NOTEXACTI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_TYPEPOSSTAR, 0,       /* TYPESTAR, TYPEMINSTAR */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_TYPEPOSPLUS, 0,       /* TYPEPLUS, TYPEMINPLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_TYPEPOSQUERY, 0,      /* TYPEQUERY, TYPEMINQUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_TYPEPOSUPTO, 0,       /* TYPEUPTO, TYPEMINUPTO */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0,                       /* TYPEEXACT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* TYPEPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_CRPOSSTAR, 0,         /* CRSTAR, CRMINSTAR */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_CRPOSPLUS, 0,         /* CRPLUS, CRMINPLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_CRPOSQUERY, 0,        /* CRQUERY, CRMINQUERY */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  OP_CRPOSRANGE, 0,        /* CRRANGE, CRMINRANGE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* CRPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,RANGE} */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0, 0,                 /* CLASS, NCLASS, XCLASS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0,                    /* REF, REFI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0,                    /* DNREF, DNREFI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  0, 0                     /* RECURSE, CALLOUT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								};
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*     Show the parsed pattern for debugging      *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* For debugging the pre-scan, this code, which outputs the parsed data vector,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								can be enabled. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static void show_parsed(compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *pptr = cb->parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int max, min;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_SIZE offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t length;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t meta_arg = META_DATA(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  fprintf(stderr, "+++ %02d %.8x ", (int)(pptr - cb->parsed_pattern), *pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (*pptr < META_END)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*pptr > 32 && *pptr < 128) fprintf(stderr, "%c", *pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else switch (META_CODE(*pptr++))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "**** OOPS - unknown META value - giving up ****\n");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_END:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META_END\n");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META_CAPTURE %d", meta_arg);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META_RECURSE %d %zd", meta_arg, offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg < 10)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      offset = cb->small_ref_offset[meta_arg];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META_BACKREF %d %zd", meta_arg, offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ESCAPE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg == ESC_P || meta_arg == ESC_p)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t ptype = *pptr >> 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t pvalue = *pptr++ & 0xffff;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META \\%c %d %d", (meta_arg == ESC_P)? 'P':'p',
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptype, pvalue);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t cc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* There's just one escape we might have here that isn't negated in the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      escapes table. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (meta_arg == ESC_g) cc = CHAR_g;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else for (cc = ESCAPES_FIRST; cc <= ESCAPES_LAST; cc++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (meta_arg == (uint32_t)(-escapes[cc - ESCAPES_FIRST])) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (cc > ESCAPES_LAST) cc = CHAR_QUESTION_MARK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META \\%c", cc);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    min = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    max = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}", min, max);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}", min);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    min = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    max = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}?", min, max);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}?", min);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    min = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    max = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}+", min, max);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}+", min);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BIGVALUE: fprintf(stderr, "META_BIGVALUE %.8x", *pptr++); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CIRCUMFLEX: fprintf(stderr, "META_CIRCUMFLEX"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_ASSERT: fprintf(stderr, "META_COND_ASSERT"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOLLAR: fprintf(stderr, "META_DOLLAR"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOT: fprintf(stderr, "META_DOT"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK: fprintf(stderr, "META *"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META *?"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META *+"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META +"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META +?"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META ++"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META ?"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META ??"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META ?+"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ATOMIC: fprintf(stderr, "META (?>"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_NOCAPTURE: fprintf(stderr, "META (?:"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD: fprintf(stderr, "META (?="); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: fprintf(stderr, "META (?!"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: fprintf(stderr, "META (*napla:"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SCRIPT_RUN: fprintf(stderr, "META (*sr:"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_KET: fprintf(stderr, "META )"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ALT: fprintf(stderr, "META | %d", meta_arg); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS: fprintf(stderr, "META ["); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_NOT: fprintf(stderr, "META [^"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_END: fprintf(stderr, "META ]"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_EMPTY: fprintf(stderr, "META []"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT: fprintf(stderr, "META [^]"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RANGE_LITERAL: fprintf(stderr, "META - (literal)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RANGE_ESCAPED: fprintf(stderr, "META - (escaped)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_POSIX: fprintf(stderr, "META_POSIX %d", *pptr++); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_POSIX_NEG: fprintf(stderr, "META_POSIX_NEG %d", *pptr++); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ACCEPT: fprintf(stderr, "META (*ACCEPT)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_FAIL: fprintf(stderr, "META (*FAIL)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT: fprintf(stderr, "META (*COMMIT)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE: fprintf(stderr, "META (*PRUNE)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP: fprintf(stderr, "META (*SKIP)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN: fprintf(stderr, "META (*THEN)"); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_OPTIONS: fprintf(stderr, "META_OPTIONS 0x%02x", *pptr++); break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?<= %d offset=", meta_arg);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (*naplb: %d offset=", meta_arg);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?<! %d offset=", meta_arg);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?C%d) next=%d/%d", pptr[2], pptr[0],
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       pptr[1]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t patoffset = *pptr++;    /* Offset of next pattern item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t patlength = *pptr++;    /* Length of next pattern item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "META (?Cstring) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "%zd next=%d/%d", offset, patoffset, patlength);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?(&name) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META_BACKREF_BYNAME length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META_COND_NUMBER %d offset=", pptr[SIZEOFFSET]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_DEFINE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?(DEFINE) offset=");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_VERSION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?(VERSION%s", (*pptr++ == 0)? "=" : ">=");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%d.", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%d)", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?(<name>) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?(R&name) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* This is kept as a name, because it might be. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (?(Rnumber) length=%d offset=", *pptr++);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (*MARK:");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto SHOWARG;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (*COMMIT:");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto SHOWARG;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (*PRUNE:");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto SHOWARG;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (*SKIP:");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto SHOWARG;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "META (*THEN:");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    SHOWARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    length = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for (i = 0; i < length; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t cc = *pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (cc > 32 && cc < 128) fprintf(stderr, "%c", cc);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else fprintf(stderr, "\\x{%x}", cc);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, ") length=%u", length);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  fprintf(stderr, "\n");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*               Copy compiled code               *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Compiled JIT code cannot be copied, so the new compiled block has no
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								associated JIT data. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_code_copy(const pcre2_code *code)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_code *newcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (code == NULL) return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								newcode = code->memctl.malloc(code->blocksize, code->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (newcode == NULL) return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memcpy(newcode, code, code->blocksize);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								newcode->executable_jit = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If the code is one that has been deserialized, increment the reference count
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								in the decoded tables. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((code->flags & PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(code->tables + TABLES_LENGTH);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  (*ref_count)++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return newcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*     Copy compiled code and character tables    *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Compiled JIT code cannot be copied, so the new compiled block has no
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								associated JIT data. This version of code_copy also makes a separate copy of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the character tables. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_code_copy_with_tables(const pcre2_code *code)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_code *newcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint8_t *newtables;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (code == NULL) return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								newcode = code->memctl.malloc(code->blocksize, code->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (newcode == NULL) return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memcpy(newcode, code, code->blocksize);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								newcode->executable_jit = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								newtables = code->memctl.malloc(TABLES_LENGTH + sizeof(PCRE2_SIZE),
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (newtables == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code->memctl.free((void *)newcode, code->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memcpy(newtables, code->tables, TABLES_LENGTH);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(newtables + TABLES_LENGTH);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ref_count = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								newcode->tables = newtables;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								newcode->flags |= PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return newcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*               Free compiled code               *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_EXP_DEFN void PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_code_free(pcre2_code *code)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (code != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (code->executable_jit != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PRIV(jit_free)(code->executable_jit, &code->memctl);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((code->flags & PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Decoded tables belong to the codes after deserialization, and they must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    be freed when there are no more references to them. The *ref_count should
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    always be > 0. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(code->tables + TABLES_LENGTH);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*ref_count > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      (*ref_count)--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ref_count == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code->memctl.free((void *)code->tables, code->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code->memctl.free(code, code->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*         Read a number, possibly signed         *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is used to read numbers in the pattern. The initial pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								must be the sign or first digit of the number. When relative values (introduced
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								by + or -) are allowed, they are relative group numbers, and the result must be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								greater than zero.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrptr      points to the character pointer variable
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrend      points to the end of the input string
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  allow_sign  if < 0, sign not allowed; if >= 0, sign is relative to this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  max_value   the largest number allowed
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  max_error   the error to give for an over-large number
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  intptr      where to put the result
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errcodeptr  where to put an error code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:      TRUE  - a number was read
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              FALSE - errorcode == 0 => no number was found
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                      errorcode != 0 => an error occurred
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								read_number(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, int32_t allow_sign,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t max_value, uint32_t max_error, int *intptr, int *errorcodeptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int sign = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t n = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL yield = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errorcodeptr = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (allow_sign >= 0 && ptr < ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (*ptr == CHAR_PLUS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sign = +1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    max_value -= allow_sign;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sign = -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (ptr >= ptrend || !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (ptr < ptrend && IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (n > max_value)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = max_error;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (allow_sign >= 0 && sign != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (n == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR26;  /* +0 and -0 are not allowed */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (sign > 0) n += allow_sign;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if ((int)n > allow_sign)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR15;  /* Non-existent subpattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else n = allow_sign + 1 - n;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								yield = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								EXIT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*intptr = n;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ptrptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return yield;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*         Read repeat counts                     *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Read an item of the form {n,m} and return the values if non-NULL pointers
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								are supplied. Repeat counts must be less than 65536 (MAX_REPEAT_COUNT); a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								larger value is used for "unlimited". We have to use signed arguments for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								read_number() because it is capable of returning a signed value.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrptr         points to pointer to character after'{'
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrend         pointer to end of input
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  minp           if not NULL, pointer to int for min
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  maxp           if not NULL, pointer to int for max (-1 if no max)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 returned as -1 if no max
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcodeptr   points to error code variable
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:         FALSE if not a repeat quantifier, errorcode set zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 FALSE on error, with errorcode set non-zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 TRUE on success, with pointer updated to point after '}'
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								read_repeat_counts(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, uint32_t *minp,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t *maxp, int *errorcodeptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR p;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL yield = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL had_comma = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int32_t min = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int32_t max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED; /* This value is larger than MAX_REPEAT_COUNT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Check the syntax */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errorcodeptr = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (p = *ptrptr;; p++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (p >= ptrend) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  c = *p;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (IS_DIGIT(c)) continue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c == CHAR_COMMA)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (had_comma) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    had_comma = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The only error from read_number() is for a number that is too big. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								p = *ptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, -1, MAX_REPEAT_COUNT, ERR5, &min, errorcodeptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  max = min;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (*(++p) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, -1, MAX_REPEAT_COUNT, ERR5, &max,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcodeptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (max < min)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR4;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								yield = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (minp != NULL) *minp = (uint32_t)min;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (maxp != NULL) *maxp = (uint32_t)max;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Update the pattern pointer */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								EXIT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ptrptr = p;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return yield;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*            Handle escapes                      *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called when a \ has been encountered. It either returns a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								positive value for a simple escape such as \d, or 0 for a data character, which
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is placed in chptr. A backreference to group n is returned as negative n. On
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								entry, ptr is pointing at the character after \. On exit, it points after the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								final code unit of the escape sequence.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								This function is also called from pcre2_substitute() to handle escape sequences
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								in replacement strings. In this case, the cb argument is NULL, and in the case
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								of escapes that have further processing, only sequences that define a data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								character are recognised. The isclass argument is not relevant; the options
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								argument is the final value of the compiled pattern's options.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrptr         points to the input position pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrend         points to the end of the input
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  chptr          points to a returned data character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcodeptr   points to the errorcode variable (containing zero)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options        the current options bits
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  isclass        TRUE if inside a character class
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb             compile data block or NULL when called from pcre2_substitute()
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:         zero => a data character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 positive => a special escape sequence
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 negative => a numerical back reference
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 on error, errorcodeptr is set non-zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PRIV(check_escape)(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, uint32_t *chptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t options, uint32_t extra_options, BOOL isclass,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t c, cc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int escape = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If backslash is at the end of the string, it's an error. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (ptr >= ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorcodeptr = ERR1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);         /* Get character value, increment pointer */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errorcodeptr = 0;              /* Be optimistic */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Non-alphanumerics are literals, so we just leave the value in c. An initial
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								value test saves a memory lookup for code points outside the alphanumeric
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								range. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (c < ESCAPES_FIRST || c > ESCAPES_LAST) {}  /* Definitely literal */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Otherwise, do a table lookup. Non-zero values need little processing here. A
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								positive value is a literal value for something like \n. A negative value is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the negation of one of the ESC_ macros that is passed back for handling by the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								calling function. Some extra checking is needed for \N because only \N{U+dddd}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is supported. If the value is zero, further processing is handled below. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else if ((i = escapes[c - ESCAPES_FIRST]) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (i > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    c = (uint32_t)i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_CR && (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ESCAPED_CR_IS_LF) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      c = CHAR_LF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else  /* Negative table entry */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    escape = -i;                    /* Else return a special escape */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (cb != NULL && (escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p || escape == ESC_X))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASBKPORX;   /* Note \P, \p, or \X */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Perl supports \N{name} for character names and \N{U+dddd} for numerical
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Unicode code points, as well as plain \N for "not newline". PCRE does not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    support \N{name}. However, it does support quantification such as \N{2,3},
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    so if \N{ is not followed by U+dddd we check for a quantifier. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (escape == ESC_N && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* \N{U+ can be handled by the \x{ code. However, this construction is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      not valid in EBCDIC environments because it specifies a Unicode
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      character, not a codepoint in the local code. For example \N{U+0041}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      must be "A" in all environments. Also, in Perl, \N{U+ forces Unicode
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      casing semantics for the entire pattern, so allow it only in UTF (i.e.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      Unicode) mode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptrend - p > 1 && *p == CHAR_U && p[1] == CHAR_PLUS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR93;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (utf)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr = p + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          escape = 0;   /* Not a fancy escape after all */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto COME_FROM_NU;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else *errorcodeptr = ERR93;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Give an error if what follows is not a quantifier, but don't override
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      an error set by the quantifier reader (e.g. number overflow). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (!read_repeat_counts(&p, ptrend, NULL, NULL, errorcodeptr) &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             *errorcodeptr == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Escapes that need further processing, including those that are unknown, have
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								a zero entry in the lookup table. When called from pcre2_substitute(), only \c,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								\o, and \x are recognized (\u and \U can never appear as they are used for case
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								forcing). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int s;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_SPTR oldptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL overflow;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL alt_bsux =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ((options & PCRE2_ALT_BSUX) | (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX)) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Filter calls from pcre2_substitute(). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (cb == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c != CHAR_c && c != CHAR_o && c != CHAR_x)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    alt_bsux = FALSE;   /* Do not modify \x handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  switch (c)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* A number of Perl escapes are not handled by PCRE. We give an explicit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    error. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_F:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_l:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_L:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* \u is unrecognized when neither PCRE2_ALT_BSUX nor PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    is set. Otherwise, \u must be followed by exactly four hex digits or, if
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set, by any number of hex digits in braces.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Otherwise it is a lowercase u letter. This gives some compatibility with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ECMAScript (aka JavaScript). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_u:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!alt_bsux) *errorcodeptr = ERR37; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t xc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_SPTR hptr = ptr + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cc = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        while (hptr < ptrend && (xc = XDIGIT(*hptr)) != 0xff)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if ((cc & 0xf0000000) != 0)  /* Test for 32-bit overflow */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *errorcodeptr = ERR77;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr = hptr;   /* Show where */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;        /* *hptr != } will cause another break below */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cc = (cc << 4) | xc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          hptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (hptr == ptr + 1 ||   /* No hex digits */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            hptr >= ptrend ||    /* Hit end of input */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *hptr != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)  /* No } terminator */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;         /* Hex escape not recognized */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = cc;          /* Accept the code point */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr = hptr + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else  /* Must be exactly 4 hex digits */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptrend - ptr < 4) break;               /* Less than 4 chars */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((cc = XDIGIT(ptr[0])) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[1])) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cc = (cc << 4) | xc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[2])) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cc = (cc << 4) | xc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[3])) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = (cc << 4) | xc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr += 4;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (utf)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c > 0x10ffffU) *errorcodeptr = ERR77;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (c > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR) *errorcodeptr = ERR77;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* \U is unrecognized unless PCRE2_ALT_BSUX or PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in which case it is an upper case letter. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_U:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!alt_bsux) *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In a character class, \g is just a literal "g". Outside a character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    class, \g must be followed by one of a number of specific things:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (1) A number, either plain or braced. If positive, it is an absolute
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    backreference. If negative, it is a relative backreference. This is a Perl
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    5.10 feature.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (2) Perl 5.10 also supports \g{name} as a reference to a named group. This
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    is part of Perl's movement towards a unified syntax for back references. As
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    this is synonymous with \k{name}, we fudge it up by pretending it really
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    was \k{name}.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (3) For Oniguruma compatibility we also support \g followed by a name or a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    number either in angle brackets or in single quotes. However, these are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (possibly recursive) subroutine calls, _not_ backreferences. We return
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the ESC_g code.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Summary: Return a negative number for a numerical back reference, ESC_k for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    a named back reference, and ESC_g for a named or numbered subroutine call.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_g:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (isclass) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr >= ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN || *ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      escape = ESC_g;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If there is a brace delimiter, try to read a numerical reference. If
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    there isn't one, assume we have a name and treat it as \k. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &s,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcodeptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*errorcodeptr == 0) escape = ESC_k;  /* No number found */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (p >= ptrend || *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr = p + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Read an undelimited number */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &s,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcodeptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*errorcodeptr == 0) *errorcodeptr = ERR57;  /* No number found */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (s <= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    escape = -s;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The handling of escape sequences consisting of a string of digits
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    starting with one that is not zero is not straightforward. Perl has changed
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    over the years. Nowadays \g{} for backreferences and \o{} for octal are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    recommended to avoid the ambiguities in the old syntax.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Outside a character class, the digits are read as a decimal number. If the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    number is less than 10, or if there are that many previous extracting left
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    brackets, it is a back reference. Otherwise, up to three octal digits are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    read to form an escaped character code. Thus \123 is likely to be octal 123
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (cf \0123, which is octal 012 followed by the literal 3).
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Inside a character class, \ followed by a digit is always either a literal
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    8 or 9 or an octal number. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: case CHAR_5:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!isclass)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      oldptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr--;   /* Back to the digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* As we know we are at a digit, the only possible error from
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      read_number() is a number that is too large to be a group number. In this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case we fall through handle this as not a group reference. If we have
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      read a small enough number, check for a back reference.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \1 to \9 are always back references. \8x and \9x are too; \1x to \7x
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      are octal escapes if there are not that many previous captures. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (read_number(&ptr, ptrend, -1, INT_MAX/10 - 1, 0, &s, errorcodeptr) &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (s < 10 || oldptr[-1] >= CHAR_8 || s <= (int)cb->bracount))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (s > (int)MAX_GROUP_NUMBER) *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else escape = -s;     /* Indicates a back reference */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr = oldptr;      /* Put the pointer back and fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle a digit following \ when the number is not a back reference, or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    we are within a character class. If the first digit is 8 or 9, Perl used to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    generate a binary zero and then treat the digit as a following literal. At
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    least by Perl 5.18 this changed so as not to insert the binary zero. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c >= CHAR_8) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* \0 always starts an octal number, but we may drop through to here with a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    larger first octal digit. The original code used just to take the least
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    significant 8 bits of octal numbers (I think this is what early Perls used
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    to do). Nowadays we allow for larger numbers in UTF-8 mode and 16-bit mode,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    but no more than 3 octal digits. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_0:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    c -= CHAR_0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while(i++ < 2 && ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = c * 8 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!utf && c > 0xff) *errorcodeptr = ERR51;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* \o is a relatively new Perl feature, supporting a more general way of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    specifying character codes in octal. The only supported form is \o{ddd}. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_o:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr++ != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR55;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR78;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      c = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      overflow = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cc = *ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue;     /* Leading zeroes */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c >= 0x20000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = (c << 3) + (cc - CHAR_0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (overflow)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR64;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* When PCRE2_ALT_BSUX or PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set, \x must be followed
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    by two hexadecimal digits. Otherwise it is a lowercase x letter. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_x:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (alt_bsux)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t xc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptrend - ptr < 2) break;               /* Less than 2 characters */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((cc = XDIGIT(ptr[0])) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[1])) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      c = (cc << 4) | xc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle \x in Perl's style. \x{ddd} is a character code which can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    greater than 0xff in UTF-8 or non-8bit mode, but only if the ddd are hex
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    digits. If not, { used to be treated as a data character. However, Perl
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    seems to read hex digits up to the first non-such, and ignore the rest, so
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    that, for example \x{zz} matches a binary zero. This seems crazy, so PCRE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    now gives an error. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifndef EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        COME_FROM_NU:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (++ptr >= ptrend || *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR78;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        overflow = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        while (ptr < ptrend && (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) != 0xff)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (c == 0 && cc == 0) continue;   /* Leading zeroes */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (c >= 0x10000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          c = (c << 4) | cc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if ((utf && c > 0x10ffffU) || (!utf && c > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            overflow = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (overflow)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          while (ptr < ptrend && XDIGIT(*ptr) != 0xff) ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If the sequence of hex digits does not end with '}', give an error.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        We used just to recognize this construct and fall through to the normal
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \x handling, but nowadays Perl gives an error, which seems much more
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        sensible, so we do too. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR67;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }   /* End of \x{} processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Read a up to two hex digits after \x */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr >= ptrend || (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = cc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr >= ptrend || (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) == 0xff) break;  /* Not a hex digit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = (c << 4) | cc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }     /* End of \xdd handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }       /* End of Perl-style \x handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The handling of \c is different in ASCII and EBCDIC environments. In an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ASCII (or Unicode) environment, an error is given if the character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    following \c is not a printable ASCII character. Otherwise, the following
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character is upper-cased if it is a letter, and after that the 0x40 bit is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    flipped. The result is the value of the escape.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    In an EBCDIC environment the handling of \c is compatible with the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    specification in the perlebcdic document. The following character must be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    a letter or one of small number of special characters. These provide a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    means of defining the character values 0-31.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    For testing the EBCDIC handling of \c in an ASCII environment, recognize
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the EBCDIC value of 'c' explicitly. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if defined EBCDIC && 'a' != 0x81
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case 0x83:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_c:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr >= ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    c = *ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c = UPPER_CASE(c);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle \c in an ASCII/Unicode environment. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifndef EBCDIC    /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c < 32 || c > 126)  /* Excludes all non-printable ASCII */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    c ^= 0x40;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle \c in an EBCDIC environment. The special case \c? is converted to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    255 (0xff) or 95 (0x5f) if other characters suggest we are using the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    POSIX-BC encoding. (This is the way Perl indicates that it handles \c?.)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    The other valid sequences correspond to a list of specific characters. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      c = ('\\' == 188 && '`' == 74)? 0x5f : 0xff;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c == ebcdic_escape_c[i]) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (i < 32) c = i; else *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* EBCDIC */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Any other alphanumeric following \ is an error. Perl gives an error only
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if in warning mode, but PCRE doesn't have a warning mode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *ptrptr = ptr - 1;     /* Point to the character at fault */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Set the pointer to the next character before returning. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ptrptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*chptr = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*               Handle \P and \p                 *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called after \P or \p has been encountered, provided that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2 is compiled with support for UTF and Unicode properties. On entry, the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								contents of ptrptr are pointing after the P or p. On exit, it is left pointing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								after the final code unit of the escape sequence.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrptr         the pattern position pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  negptr         a boolean that is set TRUE for negation else FALSE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptypeptr       an unsigned int that is set to the type value
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pdataptr       an unsigned int that is set to the detailed property value
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcodeptr   the error code variable
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb             the compile data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:         TRUE if the type value was found, or FALSE for an invalid type
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								get_ucp(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, BOOL *negptr, uint16_t *ptypeptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint16_t *pdataptr, int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE i, bot, top;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR name[50];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *vptr = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint16_t ptscript = PT_NOTSCRIPT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								c = *ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*negptr = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* \P or \p can be followed by a name in {}, optionally preceded by ^ for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								negation. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (*ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *negptr = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(name) / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)) - 1; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    c = *ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while (c == '_' || c == '-' || isspace(c))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      c = *ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_NUL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    name[i] = tolower(c);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((c == ':' || c == '=') && vptr == NULL) vptr = name + i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) goto ERROR_RETURN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  name[i] = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If { doesn't follow \p or \P there is just one following character, which
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								must be an ASCII letter. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else if (MAX_255(c) && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_letter) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  name[0] = tolower(c);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  name[1] = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else goto ERROR_RETURN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ptrptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If the property contains ':' or '=' we have class name and value separately
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								specified. The following are supported:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  . Bidi_Class (synonym bc), for which the property names are "bidi<name>".
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  . Script (synonym sc) for which the property name is the script name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  . Script_Extensions (synonym scx), ditto
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								As this is a small number, we currently just check the names directly. If this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								grows, a sorted table and a switch will be neater.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								For both the script properties, set a PT_xxx value so that (1) they can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								distinguished and (2) invalid script names that happen to be the name of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								another property can be diagnosed. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (vptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int offset = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_UCHAR sname[8];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *vptr = 0;   /* Terminate property name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_bidiclass) == 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_bc) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    offset = 4;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sname[0] = CHAR_b;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sname[1] = CHAR_i;  /* There is no strcpy_c8 function */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sname[2] = CHAR_d;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sname[3] = CHAR_i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_script) == 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								           PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_sc) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptscript = PT_SC;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_scriptextensions) == 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								           PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_scx) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptscript = PT_SCX;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR47;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Adjust the string in name[] as needed */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  memmove(name + offset, vptr + 1, (name + i - vptr)*sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (offset != 0) memmove(name, sname, offset*sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Search for a recognized property using binary chop. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								bot = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								top = PRIV(utt_size);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (bot < top)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int r;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  i = (bot + top) >> 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  r = PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, PRIV(utt_names) + PRIV(utt)[i].name_offset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* When a matching property is found, some extra checking is needed when the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \p{xx:yy} syntax is used and xx is either sc or scx. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (r == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *pdataptr = PRIV(utt)[i].value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (vptr == NULL || ptscript == PT_NOTSCRIPT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *ptypeptr = PRIV(utt)[i].type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch (PRIV(utt)[i].type)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case PT_SC:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *ptypeptr = PT_SC;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case PT_SCX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *ptypeptr = ptscript;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;  /* Non-script found */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (r > 0) bot = i + 1; else top = i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errorcodeptr = ERR47;   /* Unrecognized property */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ERROR_RETURN:            /* Malformed \P or \p */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errorcodeptr = ERR46;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ptrptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*           Check for POSIX class syntax         *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called when the sequence "[:" or "[." or "[=" is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								encountered in a character class. It checks whether this is followed by a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								sequence of characters terminated by a matching ":]" or ".]" or "=]". If we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								reach an unescaped ']' without the special preceding character, return FALSE.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Originally, this function only recognized a sequence of letters between the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								terminators, but it seems that Perl recognizes any sequence of characters,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								though of course unknown POSIX names are subsequently rejected. Perl gives an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								"Unknown POSIX class" error for [:f\oo:] for example, where previously PCRE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								didn't consider this to be a POSIX class. Likewise for [:1234:].
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								The problem in trying to be exactly like Perl is in the handling of escapes. We
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								have to be sure that [abc[:x\]pqr] is *not* treated as containing a POSIX
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								class, but [abc[:x\]pqr:]] is (so that an error can be generated). The code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								below handles the special cases \\ and \], but does not try to do any other
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								escape processing. This makes it different from Perl for cases such as
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								[:l\ower:] where Perl recognizes it as the POSIX class "lower" but PCRE does
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								not recognize "l\ower". This is a lesser evil than not diagnosing bad classes
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								when Perl does, I think.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								A user pointed out that PCRE was rejecting [:a[:digit:]] whereas Perl was not.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								It seems that the appearance of a nested POSIX class supersedes an apparent
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								external class. For example, [:a[:digit:]b:] matches "a", "b", ":", or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								a digit. This is handled by returning FALSE if the start of a new group with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the same terminator is encountered, since the next closing sequence must close
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the nested group, not the outer one.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								In Perl, unescaped square brackets may also appear as part of class names. For
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								example, [:a[:abc]b:] gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b:]". However, for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								[:a[:abc]b][b:] it gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b][b:]", which does not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								seem right at all. PCRE does not allow closing square brackets in POSIX class
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								names.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptr      pointer to the character after the initial [ (colon, dot, equals)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrend   pointer to the end of the pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  endptr   where to return a pointer to the terminating ':', '.', or '='
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:   TRUE or FALSE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								check_posix_syntax(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, PCRE2_SPTR *endptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR terminator;  /* Don't combine these lines; the Solaris cc */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								terminator = *ptr++;     /* compiler warns about "non-constant" initializer. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (; ptrend - ptr >= 2; ptr++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      (ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if ((*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && ptr[1] == terminator) ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if (*ptr == terminator && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *endptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*          Check POSIX class name                *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called to check the name given in a POSIX-style class entry
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								such as [:alnum:].
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptr        points to the first letter
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  len        the length of the name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:     a value representing the name, or -1 if unknown
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								check_posix_name(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, int len)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								const char *pn = posix_names;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int yield = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (posix_name_lengths[yield] != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (len == posix_name_lengths[yield] &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, pn, (unsigned int)len) == 0) return yield;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pn += posix_name_lengths[yield] + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  yield++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*       Read a subpattern or VERB name           *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called from parse_regex() below whenever it needs to read
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the name of a subpattern or a (*VERB) or an (*alpha_assertion). The initial
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pointer must be to the character before the name. If that character is '*' we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								are reading a verb or alpha assertion name. The pointer is updated to point
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								after the name, for a VERB or alpha assertion name, or after tha name's
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								terminator for a subpattern name. Returning both the offset and the name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pointer is redundant information, but some callers use one and some the other,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								so it is simplest just to return both.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrptr      points to the character pointer variable
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptrend      points to the end of the input string
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  utf         true if the input is UTF-encoded
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  terminator  the terminator of a subpattern name must be this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  offsetptr   where to put the offset from the start of the pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  nameptr     where to put a pointer to the name in the input
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  namelenptr  where to put the length of the name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errcodeptr  where to put an error code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb          pointer to the compile data block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:    TRUE if a name was read
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            FALSE otherwise, with error code set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								read_name(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, BOOL utf, uint32_t terminator,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_SIZE *offsetptr, PCRE2_SPTR *nameptr, uint32_t *namelenptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL is_group = (*ptr != CHAR_ASTERISK);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (++ptr >= ptrend)               /* No characters in name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorcodeptr = is_group? ERR62: /* Subpattern name expected */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            ERR60; /* Verb not recognized or malformed */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*nameptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*offsetptr = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* In UTF mode, a group name may contain letters and decimal digits as defined
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								by Unicode properties, and underscores, but must not start with a digit. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (utf && is_group)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t c, type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  GETCHAR(c, ptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  type = UCD_CHARTYPE(c);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (type == ucp_Nd)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR44;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for(;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (type != ucp_Nd && PRIV(ucp_gentype)[type] != ucp_L &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c != CHAR_UNDERSCORE) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    FORWARDCHARTEST(ptr, ptrend);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr >= ptrend) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETCHAR(c, ptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    type = UCD_CHARTYPE(c);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								(void)utf;  /* Avoid compiler warning */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif      /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Handle non-group names and group names in non-UTF modes. A group name must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								not start with a digit. If either of the others start with a digit it just
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								won't be recognized. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (is_group && IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR44;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  while (ptr < ptrend && MAX_255(*ptr) && (cb->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Check name length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (ptr > *nameptr + MAX_NAME_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorcodeptr = ERR48;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*namelenptr = (uint32_t)(ptr - *nameptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Subpattern names must not be empty, and their terminator is checked here.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								(What follows a verb or alpha assertion name is checked separately.) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (is_group)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (ptr == *nameptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR62;   /* Subpattern name expected */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != (PCRE2_UCHAR)terminator)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorcodeptr = ERR42;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ptrptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								FAILED:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ptrptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*          Manage callouts at start of cycle     *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* At the start of a new item in parse_regex() we are able to record the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								details of the previous item in a prior callout, and also to set up an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								automatic callout if enabled. Avoid having two adjacent automatic callouts,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								which would otherwise happen for items such as \Q that contribute nothing to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the parsed pattern.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptr              current pattern pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pcalloutptr      points to a pointer to previous callout, or NULL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  auto_callout     TRUE if auto_callouts are enabled
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_pattern   the parsed pattern pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb               compile block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns: possibly updated parsed_pattern pointer.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static uint32_t *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								manage_callouts(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, uint32_t **pcalloutptr, BOOL auto_callout,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t *parsed_pattern, compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *previous_callout = *pcalloutptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (previous_callout != NULL) previous_callout[2] = (uint32_t)(ptr -
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb->start_pattern - (PCRE2_SIZE)previous_callout[1]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (!auto_callout) previous_callout = NULL; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (previous_callout == NULL ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      previous_callout != parsed_pattern - 4 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      previous_callout[3] != 255)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    previous_callout = parsed_pattern;  /* Set up new automatic callout */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    parsed_pattern += 4;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    previous_callout[0] = META_CALLOUT_NUMBER;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    previous_callout[2] = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    previous_callout[3] = 255;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  previous_callout[1] = (uint32_t)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*pcalloutptr = previous_callout;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*      Parse regex and identify named groups     *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called first of all. It scans the pattern and does two
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								things: (1) It identifies capturing groups and makes a table of named capturing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								groups so that information about them is fully available to both the compiling
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								scans. (2) It writes a parsed version of the pattern with comments omitted and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								escapes processed into the parsed_pattern vector.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ptr             points to the start of the pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options         compiling dynamic options (may change during the scan)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  has_lookbehind  points to a boolean, set TRUE if a lookbehind is found
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb              pointer to the compile data block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:   zero on success or a non-zero error code, with the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             error offset placed in the cb field
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* A structure and some flags for dealing with nested groups. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								typedef struct nest_save {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint16_t  nest_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint16_t  reset_group;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint16_t  max_group;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint16_t  flags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t  options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								} nest_save;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define NSF_RESET          0x0001u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define NSF_CONDASSERT     0x0002u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define NSF_ATOMICSR       0x0004u
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Options that are changeable within the pattern must be tracked during
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								parsing. Some (e.g. PCRE2_EXTENDED) are implemented entirely during parsing,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								but all must be tracked so that META_OPTIONS items set the correct values for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the main compiling phase. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS (PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_DUPNAMES| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE|PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE| \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_UNGREEDY)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* States used for analyzing ranges in character classes. The two OK values
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								must be last. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								enum { RANGE_NO, RANGE_STARTED, RANGE_OK_ESCAPED, RANGE_OK_LITERAL };
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Only in 32-bit mode can there be literals > META_END. A macro encapsulates
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the storing of literal values in the main parsed pattern, where they can always
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								be quantified. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PARSED_LITERAL(c, p) \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  { \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c >= META_END) *p++ = META_BIGVALUE; \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *p++ = c; \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  okquantifier = TRUE; \
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define PARSED_LITERAL(c, p) *p++ = c; okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Here's the actual function. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int parse_regex(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, uint32_t options, BOOL *has_lookbehind,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t delimiter;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t namelen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t class_range_state;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *verblengthptr = NULL;     /* Value avoids compiler warning */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *verbstartptr = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *previous_callout = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *parsed_pattern = cb->parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *parsed_pattern_end = cb->parsed_pattern_end;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t meta_quantifier = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t add_after_mark = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t extra_options = cb->cx->extra_options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint16_t nest_depth = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int after_manual_callout = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int expect_cond_assert = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int errorcode = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL inescq = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL inverbname = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL auto_callout = (options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL isdupname;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL negate_class;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL okquantifier = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR thisptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR name;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR ptrend = cb->end_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR verbnamestart = NULL;    /* Value avoids compiler warning */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								named_group *ng;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								nest_save *top_nest, *end_nests;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Insert leading items for word and line matching (features provided for the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								benefit of pcre2grep). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_CIRCUMFLEX;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If the pattern is actually a literal string, process it separately to avoid
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cluttering up the main loop. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  while (ptr < ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR63;  /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    thisptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (auto_callout)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        auto_callout, parsed_pattern, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto PARSED_END;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Process a real regex which may contain meta-characters. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								top_nest = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								end_nests = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The size of the nest_save structure might not be a factor of the size of the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								workspace. Therefore we must round down end_nests so as to correctly avoid
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								creating a nest_save that spans the end of the workspace. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								end_nests = (nest_save *)((char *)end_nests -
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ((cb->workspace_size * sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)) % sizeof(nest_save)));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE implies PCRE2_EXTENDED */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0) options |= PCRE2_EXTENDED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Now scan the pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (ptr < ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int prev_expect_cond_assert;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t min_repeat, max_repeat;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t set, unset, *optset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t terminator;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t prev_meta_quantifier;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL prev_okquantifier;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_SPTR tempptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_SIZE offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    errorcode = ERR63;  /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (nest_depth > cb->cx->parens_nest_limit)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    errorcode = ERR19;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto FAILED;        /* Parentheses too deeply nested */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Get next input character, save its position for callout handling. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  thisptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Copy quoted literals until \E, allowing for the possibility of automatic
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  callouts, except when processing a (*VERB) "name".  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (inescq)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      inescq = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;   /* Skip E */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (expect_cond_assert > 0)   /* A literal is not allowed if we are */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {                           /* expecting a conditional assertion, */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr--;                      /* but an empty \Q\E sequence is OK.  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR28;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (inverbname)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {                          /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32    /* sets okquantifier. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (after_manual_callout-- <= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            auto_callout, parsed_pattern, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      meta_quantifier = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    continue;  /* Next character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If we are processing the "name" part of a (*VERB:NAME) item, all
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  characters up to the closing parenthesis are literals except when
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES is set. That causes backslash interpretation, but only \Q
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  and \E and escaped characters are allowed (no character types such as \d). If
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_EXTENDED is also set, we must ignore white space and # comments. Do
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  this by not entering the special (*VERB:NAME) processing - they are then
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  picked up below. Note that c is a character, not a code unit, so we must not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  use MAX_255 to test its size because MAX_255 tests code units and is assumed
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  TRUE in 8-bit mode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (inverbname &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       (
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* EITHER: not both options set */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ((options & (PCRE2_EXTENDED | PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES)) !=
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    (PCRE2_EXTENDED | PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES)) ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* OR: character > 255 AND not Unicode Pattern White Space */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (c > 255 && (c|1) != 0x200f && (c|1) != 0x2029) ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* OR: not a # comment or isspace() white space */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (c < 256 && c != CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) == 0
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* and not CHAR_NEL when Unicode is supported */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          && c != CHAR_NEL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       )))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PCRE2_SIZE verbnamelength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch(c)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      default:                     /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32    /* sets okquantifier. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      inverbname = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* This is the length in characters */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      verbnamelength = (PCRE2_SIZE)(parsed_pattern - verblengthptr - 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* But the limit on the length is in code units */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr - verbnamestart - 1 > (int)MAX_MARK)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR76;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *verblengthptr = (uint32_t)verbnamelength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If this name was on a verb such as (*ACCEPT) which does not continue,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      a (*MARK) was generated for the name. We now add the original verb as the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      next item. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (add_after_mark != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = add_after_mark;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        add_after_mark = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_BACKSLASH:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((options & PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->cx->extra_options, FALSE, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else escape = 0;   /* Treat all as literal */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      switch(escape)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case 0:                    /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32    /* sets okquantifier. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case ESC_Q:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        inescq = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case ESC_E:           /* Ignore */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR40;    /* Invalid in verb name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    continue;   /* Next character in pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Not a verb name character. At this point we must process everything that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  must not change the quantification state. This is mainly comments, but we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  handle \Q and \E here as well, so that an item such as A\Q\E+ is treated as
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  A+, as in Perl. An isolated \E is ignored. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*ptr == CHAR_Q || *ptr == CHAR_E)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      inescq = *ptr == CHAR_Q;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      continue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Skip over whitespace and # comments in extended mode. Note that c is a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  character, not a code unit, so we must not use MAX_255 to test its size
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  because MAX_255 tests code units and is assumed TRUE in 8-bit mode. The
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  whitespace characters are those designated as "Pattern White Space" by
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  Unicode, which are the isspace() characters plus CHAR_NEL (newline), which is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  U+0085 in Unicode, plus U+200E, U+200F, U+2028, and U+2029. These are a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  subset of space characters that match \h and \v. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c < 256 && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) != 0) continue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_NEL || (c|1) == 0x200f || (c|1) == 0x2029) continue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      while (ptr < ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (IS_NEWLINE(ptr))      /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {                       /* IS_NEWLINE sets cb->nllen. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr += cb->nllen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (utf) FORWARDCHARTEST(ptr, ptrend);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      continue;  /* Next character in pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Skip over bracketed comments */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptrend - ptr >= 2 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr[0] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && ptr[1] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while (++ptr < ptrend && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr >= ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR18;  /* A special error for missing ) in a comment */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto FAILED;        /* to make it easier to debug. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    continue;  /* Next character in pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If the next item is not a quantifier, fill in length of any previous
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  callout and create an auto callout if required. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c != CHAR_ASTERISK && c != CHAR_PLUS && c != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       (c != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         (tempptr = ptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         !read_repeat_counts(&tempptr, ptrend, NULL, NULL, &errorcode))))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (after_manual_callout-- <= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout, auto_callout,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        parsed_pattern, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If expect_cond_assert is 2, we have just passed (?( and are expecting an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  assertion, possibly preceded by a callout. If the value is 1, we have just
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  had the callout and expect an assertion. There must be at least 3 more
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  characters in all cases. When expect_cond_assert is 2, we know that the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  current character is an opening parenthesis, as otherwise we wouldn't be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  here. However, when it is 1, we need to check, and it's easiest just to check
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  always. Note that expect_cond_assert may be negative, since all callouts just
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  decrement it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (expect_cond_assert > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    BOOL ok = c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptrend - ptr >= 3 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              (ptr[0] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ok)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK)  /* New alpha assertion format, possibly */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ok = MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (cb->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_lcletter) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else switch(ptr[1])  /* Traditional symbolic format */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case CHAR_C:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ok = expect_cond_assert == 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ok = ptr[2] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || ptr[2] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ok = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!ok)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr--;   /* Adjust error offset */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR28;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Remember whether we are expecting a conditional assertion, and set the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  default for this item. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  prev_expect_cond_assert = expect_cond_assert;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  expect_cond_assert = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Remember quantification status for the previous significant item, then set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  default for this item. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  prev_okquantifier = okquantifier;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  prev_meta_quantifier = meta_quantifier;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  okquantifier = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  meta_quantifier = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If the previous significant item was a quantifier, adjust the parsed code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if there is a following modifier. The base meta value is always followed by
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  the PLUS and QUERY values, in that order. We do this here rather than after
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reading a quantifier so that intervening comments and /x whitespace can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ignored without having to replicate code. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (prev_meta_quantifier != 0 && (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || c == CHAR_PLUS))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    parsed_pattern[(prev_meta_quantifier == META_MINMAX)? -3 : -1] =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      prev_meta_quantifier + ((c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        0x00020000u : 0x00010000u);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    continue;  /* Next character in pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Process the next item in the main part of a pattern. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  switch(c)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:              /* Non-special character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Escape sequence ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_BACKSLASH:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    tempptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->cx->extra_options, FALSE, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (errorcode != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ESCAPE_FAILED:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr = tempptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend) c = CHAR_BACKSLASH; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);   /* Get character value, increment pointer */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      escape = 0;                 /* Treat as literal character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The escape was a data escape or literal character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (escape == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The escape was a back (or forward) reference. We keep the offset in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    order to give a more useful diagnostic for a bad forward reference. For
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    references to groups numbered less than 10 we can't use more than two items
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in parsed_pattern because they may be just two characters in the input (and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in a 64-bit world an offset may need two elements). So for them, the offset
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    of the first occurrent is held in a special vector. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else if (escape < 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      escape = -escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_BACKREF | (uint32_t)escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (escape < 10)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (cb->small_ref_offset[escape] == PCRE2_UNSET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->small_ref_offset[escape] = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The escape was a character class such as \d etc. or other special
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    escape indicator such as \A or \X. Most of them generate just a single
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    parsed item, but \P and \p are followed by a 16-bit type and a 16-bit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    value. They are supported only when Unicode is available. The type and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    value are packed into a single 32-bit value so that the whole sequences
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    uses only two elements in the parsed_vector. This is because the same
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    coding is used if \d (for example) is turned into \p{Nd} when PCRE2_UCP is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    set.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    There are also some cases where the escape sequence is followed by a name:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \k{name}, \k<name>, and \k'name' are backreferences by name, and \g<name>
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    and \g'name' are subroutine calls by name; \g{name} is a synonym for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \k{name}. Note that \g<number> and \g'number' are handled by check_escape()
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    and returned as a negative value (handled above). A name is coded as an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    offset into the pattern and a length. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else switch (escape)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_C:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef NEVER_BACKSLASH_C
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR85;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((options & PCRE2_NEVER_BACKSLASH_C) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR83;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_X:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifndef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR45;   /* Supported only with Unicode support */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_H:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_h:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_N:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_R:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_V:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_v:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      default:  /* \A, \B, \b, \G, \K, \Z, \z cannot be quantified. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Escapes that change in UCP mode. Note that PCRE2_UCP will never be set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      without Unicode support because it is checked when pcre2_compile() is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      called. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_d:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_D:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_s:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_S:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_w:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_W:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ((escape == ESC_d || escape == ESC_s || escape == ESC_w)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ESC_p : ESC_P);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        switch(escape)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_d:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_D:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = (PT_PC << 16) | ucp_Nd;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_s:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_S:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = PT_SPACE << 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_w:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_W:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Unicode property matching */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_P:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_p:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        BOOL negated;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint16_t ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, &errorcode, cb))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (negated) escape = (escape == ESC_P)? ESC_p : ESC_P;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pdata;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR45;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* End \P and \p */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* When \g is used with quotes or angle brackets as delimiters, it is a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      numerical or named subroutine call, and control comes here. When used
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      with brace delimiters it is a numberical back reference and does not come
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      here because check_escape() returns it directly as a reference. \k is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      always a named back reference. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_g:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_k:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend || (*ptr != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *ptr != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN && *ptr != CHAR_APOSTROPHE))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = (escape == ESC_g)? ERR57 : ERR69;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      terminator = (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        CHAR_APOSTROPHE : CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* For a non-braced \g, check for a numerical recursion. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (escape == ESC_g && terminator != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (read_number(&p, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &i,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            &errorcode))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (p >= ptrend || *p != terminator)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR57;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr = p;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto SET_RECURSION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (errorcode != 0) goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Not a numerical recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &errorcode, cb)) goto ESCAPE_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* \k and \g when used with braces are back references, whereas \g used
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      with quotes or angle brackets is a recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (escape == ESC_k || terminator == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          META_BACKREF_BYNAME : META_RECURSE_BYNAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* End special escape processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;    /* End escape sequence processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Single-character special items ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = META_CIRCUMFLEX;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_DOLLAR_SIGN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = META_DOLLAR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_DOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = META_DOT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Single-character quantifiers ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_ASTERISK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    meta_quantifier = META_ASTERISK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    meta_quantifier = META_PLUS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_QUESTION_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    meta_quantifier = META_QUERY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Potential {n,m} quantifier ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!read_repeat_counts(&ptr, ptrend, &min_repeat, &max_repeat,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        &errorcode))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED;     /* Error in quantifier. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);   /* Not a quantifier */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;                               /* No more quantifier processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    meta_quantifier = META_MINMAX;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Quantifier post-processing ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Check that a quantifier is allowed after the previous item. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    CHECK_QUANTIFIER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!prev_okquantifier)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR9;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto FAILED_BACK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Most (*VERB)s are not allowed to be quantified, but an ungreedy
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    quantifier can be useful for (*ACCEPT) - meaning "succeed on backtrack", a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sort of negated (*COMMIT). We therefore allow (*ACCEPT) to be quantified by
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    wrapping it in non-capturing brackets, but we have to allow for a preceding
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (*MARK) for when (*ACCEPT) has an argument. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (parsed_pattern[-1] == META_ACCEPT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t *p;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for (p = parsed_pattern - 1; p >= verbstartptr; p--) p[1] = p[0];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *verbstartptr = META_NOCAPTURE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      parsed_pattern[1] = META_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      parsed_pattern += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Now we can put the quantifier into the parsed pattern vector. At this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    stage, we have only the basic quantifier. The check for a following + or ?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    modifier happens at the top of the loop, after any intervening comments
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    have been removed. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = meta_quantifier;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = min_repeat;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = max_repeat;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Character class ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In another (POSIX) regex library, the ugly syntax [[:<:]] and [[:>:]] is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    used for "start of word" and "end of word". As these are otherwise illegal
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    sequences, we don't break anything by recognizing them. They are replaced
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    by \b(?=\w) and \b(?<=\w) respectively. Sequences like [a[:<:]] are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    erroneous and are handled by the normal code below. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptrend - ptr >= 6 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         (PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_WEIRD_STARTWORD, 6) == 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_WEIRD_ENDWORD, 6) == 0))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr[2] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKBEHIND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *has_lookbehind = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* The offset is used only for the "non-fixed length" error; this won't
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        occur here, so just store zero. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUTOFFSET((PCRE2_SIZE)0, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_w;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_p;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr += 6;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* PCRE supports POSIX class stuff inside a class. Perl gives an error if
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    they are encountered at the top level, so we'll do that too. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr < ptrend && (*ptr == CHAR_COLON || *ptr == CHAR_DOT ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         *ptr == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        check_posix_syntax(ptr, ptrend, &tempptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = (*ptr-- == CHAR_COLON)? ERR12 : ERR13;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Process a regular character class. If the first character is '^', set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the negation flag. If the first few characters (either before or after ^)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    are \Q\E or \E or space or tab in extended-more mode, we skip them too.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    This makes for compatibility with Perl. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    negate_class = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while (ptr < ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E) ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (ptrend - ptr >= 3 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STR_Q STR_BACKSLASH STR_E, 3) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               (c == CHAR_SPACE || c == CHAR_HT))  /* Note: just these two */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        continue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (!negate_class && c == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        negate_class = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Now the real contents of the class; c has the first "real" character.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Empty classes are permitted only if the option is set. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (cb->external_options & PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = negate_class? META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT : META_CLASS_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* End of class processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Process a non-empty class. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = negate_class? META_CLASS_NOT : META_CLASS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In an EBCDIC environment, Perl treats alphabetic ranges specially
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    because there are holes in the encoding, and simply using the range A-Z
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (for example) would include the characters in the holes. This applies only
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    to ranges where both values are literal; [\xC1-\xE9] is different to [A-Z]
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in this respect. In order to accommodate this, we keep track of whether
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character values are literal or not, and a state variable for handling
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ranges. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Loop for the contents of the class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for (;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      BOOL char_is_literal = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Inside \Q...\E everything is literal except \E */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (inescq)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          inescq = FALSE;                   /* Reset literal state */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;                            /* Skip the 'E' */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto CLASS_LITERAL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Skip over space and tab (only) in extended-more mode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (c == CHAR_SPACE || c == CHAR_HT))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle POSIX class names. Perl allows a negation extension of the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      form [:^name:]. A square bracket that doesn't match the syntax is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      treated as a literal. We also recognize the POSIX constructions
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      [.ch.] and [=ch=] ("collating elements") and fault them, as Perl
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      5.6 and 5.8 do. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (c == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptrend - ptr >= 3 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (*ptr == CHAR_COLON || *ptr == CHAR_DOT ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								           *ptr == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          check_posix_syntax(ptr, ptrend, &tempptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        BOOL posix_negate = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int posix_class;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Perl treats a hyphen before a POSIX class as a literal, not the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        start of a range. However, it gives a warning in its warning mode. PCRE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        does not have a warning mode, so we give an error, because this is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        likely an error on the user's part. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR50;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr != CHAR_COLON)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR13;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED_BACK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*(++ptr) == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          posix_negate = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        posix_class = check_posix_name(ptr, (int)(tempptr - ptr));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (posix_class < 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR30;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr = tempptr + 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Perl treats a hyphen after a POSIX class as a literal, not the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        start of a range. However, it gives a warning in its warning mode
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        unless the hyphen is the last character in the class. PCRE does not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        have a warning mode, so we give an error, because this is likely an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        error on the user's part. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr < ptrend - 1 && *ptr == CHAR_MINUS &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr[1] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR50;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Set "a hyphen is not the start of a range" for the -] case, and also
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        in case the POSIX class is followed by \E or \Q\E (possibly repeated -
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        fuzzers do that kind of thing) and *then* a hyphen. This causes that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        hyphen to be treated as a literal. I don't think it's worth setting up
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        special apparatus to do otherwise. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* When PCRE2_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        use Unicode properties \p or \P or, in one case, \h or \H. The
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        substitutes table has two values per class, containing the type and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        value of a \p or \P item. The special cases are specified with a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        negative type: a non-zero value causes \h or \H to be used, and a zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        value falls through to behave like a non-UCP POSIX class. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          int ptype = posix_substitutes[2*posix_class];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          int pvalue = posix_substitutes[2*posix_class + 1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (ptype >= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + (posix_negate? ESC_P : ESC_p);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pvalue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (pvalue != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + (posix_negate? ESC_H : ESC_h);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Non-UCP POSIX class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = posix_negate? META_POSIX_NEG : META_POSIX;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = posix_class;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle potential start of range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (c == CHAR_MINUS && class_range_state >= RANGE_OK_ESCAPED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = (class_range_state == RANGE_OK_LITERAL)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          META_RANGE_LITERAL : META_RANGE_ESCAPED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        class_range_state = RANGE_STARTED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle a literal character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (c != CHAR_BACKSLASH)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        CLASS_LITERAL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (c == parsed_pattern[-2])       /* Optimize one-char range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            parsed_pattern--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else if (parsed_pattern[-2] > c)   /* Check range is in order */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR8;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto FAILED_BACK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (!char_is_literal && parsed_pattern[-1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              parsed_pattern[-1] = META_RANGE_ESCAPED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else  /* Potential start of range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          class_range_state = char_is_literal?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            RANGE_OK_LITERAL : RANGE_OK_ESCAPED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle escapes in a class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        tempptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->cx->extra_options, TRUE, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (errorcode != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr = tempptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (ptr >= ptrend) c = CHAR_BACKSLASH; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);   /* Get character value, increment pointer */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          escape = 0;                 /* Treat as literal character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        switch(escape)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case 0:  /* Escaped character code point is in c */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          char_is_literal = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CLASS_LITERAL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_b:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          c = CHAR_BS;    /* \b is backspace in a class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          char_is_literal = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CLASS_LITERAL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_Q:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          inescq = TRUE;  /* Enter literal mode */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_E:     /* Ignore orphan \E */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CLASS_CONTINUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_B:     /* Always an error in a class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_R:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_X:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR7;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* The second part of a range can be a single-character escape
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        sequence (detected above), but not any of the other escapes. Perl
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        treats a hyphen as a literal in such circumstances. However, in Perl's
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        warning mode, a warning is given, so PCRE now faults it, as it is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        almost certainly a mistake on the user's part. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR50;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;  /* Not CLASS_ESCAPE_FAILED; always an error */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Of the remaining escapes, only those that define characters are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        allowed in a class. None may start a range. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        switch(escape)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_N:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR71;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_H:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_h:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_V:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_v:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* These escapes are converted to Unicode property tests when
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PCRE2_UCP is set. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_d:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_D:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_s:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_S:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_w:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_W:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              ((escape == ESC_d || escape == ESC_s || escape == ESC_w)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                ESC_p : ESC_P);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            switch(escape)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              case ESC_d:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              case ESC_D:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *parsed_pattern++ = (PT_PC << 16) | ucp_Nd;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              case ESC_s:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              case ESC_S:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *parsed_pattern++ = PT_SPACE << 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              case ESC_w:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              case ESC_W:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Explicit Unicode property matching */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_P:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_p:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            BOOL negated;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            uint16_t ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, &errorcode, cb))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (negated) escape = (escape == ESC_P)? ESC_p : ESC_P;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pdata;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR45;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;  /* End \P and \p */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          default:    /* All others are not allowed in a class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR7;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Perl gives a warning unless a following hyphen is the last character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        in the class. PCRE throws an error. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr < ptrend - 1 && *ptr == CHAR_MINUS &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr[1] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR50;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Proceed to next thing in the class. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      CLASS_CONTINUE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR6;  /* Missing terminating ']' */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET && !inescq) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }     /* End of class-processing loop */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* -] at the end of a class is a literal '-' */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      parsed_pattern[-1] = CHAR_MINUS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      class_range_state = RANGE_NO;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = META_CLASS_END;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;  /* End of character class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Opening parenthesis ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If ( is not followed by ? it is either a capture or a special verb or an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    alpha assertion or a positive non-atomic lookahead. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*ptr != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      const char *vn;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle capturing brackets (or non-capturing if auto-capture is turned
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      off). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr != CHAR_ASTERISK)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        nest_depth++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((options & PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (cb->bracount >= MAX_GROUP_NUMBER)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR97;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->bracount++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = META_CAPTURE | cb->bracount;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Do nothing for (* followed by end of pattern or ) so it gives a "bad
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      quantifier" error rather than "(*MARK) must have an argument". */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (ptrend - ptr <= 1 || (c = ptr[1]) == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle "alpha assertions" such as (*pla:...). Most of these are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      synonyms for the historical symbolic assertions, but the script run and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      non-atomic lookaround ones are new. They are distinguished by starting
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      with a lower case letter. Checking both ends of the alphabet makes this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      work in all character codes. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (CHMAX_255(c) && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_lcletter) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint32_t meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        vn = alasnames;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, 0, &offset, &name, &namelen,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR95;  /* Malformed */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Scan the table of alpha assertion names */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        for (i = 0; i < alascount; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (namelen == alasmeta[i].len &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, vn, namelen) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          vn += alasmeta[i].len + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (i >= alascount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR95;  /* Alpha assertion not recognized */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Check for expecting an assertion condition. If so, only atomic
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        lookaround assertions are valid. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        meta = alasmeta[i].meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (prev_expect_cond_assert > 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            (meta < META_LOOKAHEAD || meta > META_LOOKBEHINDNOT))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = (meta == META_LOOKAHEAD_NA || meta == META_LOOKBEHIND_NA)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ERR98 : ERR28;  /* (Atomic) assertion expected */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* The lookaround alphabetic synonyms can mostly be handled by jumping
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        to the code that handles the traditional symbolic forms. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        switch(meta)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR89;  /* Unknown code; should never occur because */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;        /* the meta values come from a table above. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_ATOMIC:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto ATOMIC_GROUP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_LOOKAHEAD:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto POSITIVE_LOOK_AHEAD;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto POSITIVE_NONATOMIC_LOOK_AHEAD;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto NEGATIVE_LOOK_AHEAD;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_LOOKBEHIND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto POST_LOOKBEHIND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* The script run facilities are handled here. Unicode support is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          required (give an error if not, as this is a security issue). Always
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          record a META_SCRIPT_RUN item. Then, for the atomic version, insert
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          META_ATOMIC and remember that we need two META_KETs at the end. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = META_SCRIPT_RUN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          nest_depth++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (meta == META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = META_ATOMIC;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else if (++top_nest >= end_nests)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              errorcode = ERR84;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            top_nest->flags = NSF_ATOMICSR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR96;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Handle (*VERB) and (*VERB:NAME) ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        vn = verbnames;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, 0, &offset, &name, &namelen,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr >= ptrend || (*ptr != CHAR_COLON &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                              *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR60;  /* Malformed */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Scan the table of verb names */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        for (i = 0; i < verbcount; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (namelen == verbs[i].len &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, vn, namelen) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          vn += verbs[i].len + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (i >= verbcount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR60;  /* Verb not recognized */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* An empty argument is treated as no argument. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr == CHAR_COLON && ptr + 1 < ptrend &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;    /* Advance to the closing parens */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Check for mandatory non-empty argument; this is (*MARK) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (verbs[i].has_arg > 0 && *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR66;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Remember where this verb, possibly with a preceding (*MARK), starts,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        for handling quantified (*ACCEPT). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        verbstartptr = parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        okquantifier = (verbs[i].meta == META_ACCEPT);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* It appears that Perl allows any characters whatsoever, other than a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        closing parenthesis, to appear in arguments ("names"), so we no longer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        insist on letters, digits, and underscores. Perl does not, however, do
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        any interpretation within arguments, and has no means of including a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        closing parenthesis. PCRE supports escape processing but only when it
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        is requested by an option. We set inverbname TRUE here, and let the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        main loop take care of this so that escape and \x processing is done by
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        the main code above. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr++ == CHAR_COLON)   /* Skip past : or ) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Some optional arguments can be treated as a preceding (*MARK) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (verbs[i].has_arg < 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            add_after_mark = verbs[i].meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = META_MARK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* The remaining verbs with arguments (except *MARK) need a different
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          opcode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern++ = verbs[i].meta +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              ((verbs[i].meta != META_MARK)? 0x00010000u:0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Set up for reading the name in the main loop. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          verblengthptr = parsed_pattern++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          verbnamestart = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          inverbname = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else  /* No verb "name" argument */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = verbs[i].meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }     /* End of (*VERB) handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* Done with this parenthesis */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }       /* End of groups that don't start with (? */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Items starting (? ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The type of item is determined by what follows (?. Handle (?| and option
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    changes under "default" because both need a new block on the nest stack.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Comments starting with (?# are handled above. Note that there is some
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ambiguity about the sequence (?- because if a digit follows it's a relative
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    recursion or subroutine call whereas otherwise it's an option unsetting. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch(*ptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS && ptrend - ptr > 1 && IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto RECURSION_BYNUMBER;  /* The + case is handled by CHAR_PLUS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* We now have either (?| or a (possibly empty) option setting,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      optionally followed by a non-capturing group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      nest_depth++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (++top_nest >= end_nests)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR84;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      top_nest->flags = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Start of non-capturing group that resets the capture count for each
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      branch. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr == CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->reset_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->max_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->flags |= NSF_RESET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Scan for options imnsxJU to be set or unset. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        BOOL hyphenok = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint32_t oldoptions = options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->reset_group = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->max_group = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        set = unset = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        optset = &set;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* ^ at the start unsets imnsx and disables the subsequent use of - */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          options &= ~(PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE|
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                       PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          hyphenok = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                               *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          switch (*ptr++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_MINUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (!hyphenok)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              errorcode = ERR94;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              ptr--;  /* Correct the offset */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            optset = &unset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            hyphenok = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_J:  /* Record that it changed in the external options */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *optset |= PCRE2_DUPNAMES;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_JCHANGED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_i: *optset |= PCRE2_CASELESS; break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_m: *optset |= PCRE2_MULTILINE; break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_n: *optset |= PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE; break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_s: *optset |= PCRE2_DOTALL; break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_U: *optset |= PCRE2_UNGREEDY; break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* If x appears twice it sets the extended extended option. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            case CHAR_x:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *optset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_x)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *optset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR11;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr--;    /* Correct the offset */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If we are setting extended without extended-more, ensure that any
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        existing extended-more gets unset. Also, unsetting extended must also
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        unset extended-more. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((set & (PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE)) == PCRE2_EXTENDED ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            (unset & PCRE2_EXTENDED) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          unset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        options = (options | set) & (~unset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If the options ended with ')' this is not the start of a nested
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        group with option changes, so the options change at this level.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        In this case, if the previous level set up a nest block, discard the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        one we have just created. Otherwise adjust it for the previous level.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        If the options ended with ':' we are starting a non-capturing group,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        possibly with an options setting. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          nest_depth--;  /* This is not a nested group after all. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (top_nest > (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace) &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              (top_nest-1)->nest_depth == nest_depth) top_nest--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If nothing changed, no need to record. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (options != oldoptions)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = META_OPTIONS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern++ = options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }     /* End options processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* End default case after (? */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Python syntax support ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_P:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* (?P<name> is the same as (?<name>, which defines a named group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto DEFINE_NAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* (?P>name) is the same as (?&name), which is a recursion or subroutine
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      call. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN) goto RECURSE_BY_NAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* (?P=name) is the same as \k<name>, a back reference by name. Anything
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else after (?P is an error. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR41;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, &offset, &name,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &namelen, &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_BACKREF_BYNAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;   /* End of (?P processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Recursion/subroutine calls by number ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_R:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      i = 0;         /* (?R) == (?R0) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR58;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto SET_RECURSION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* An item starting (?- followed by a digit comes here via the "default"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case because (?- followed by a non-digit is an options setting. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptrend - ptr < 2 || !IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR29;   /* Missing number */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_0: case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_5: case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      RECURSION_BYNUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))? -1:(int)(cb->bracount), /* + and - are relative */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &i, &errorcode)) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (i < 0)  /* NB (?0) is permitted */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR15;   /* Unknown group */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED_BACK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      SET_RECURSION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_RECURSE | (uint32_t)i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* End of recursive call by number handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Recursion/subroutine calls by name ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_AMPERSAND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      RECURSE_BY_NAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, &offset, &name,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &namelen, &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_RECURSE_BYNAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Callout with numerical or string argument ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_C:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the previous item was a condition starting (?(? an assertion,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      optionally preceded by a callout, is expected. This is checked later on,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      during actual compilation. However we need to identify this kind of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      assertion in this pass because it must not be qualified. The value of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      expect_cond_assert is set to 2 after (?(? is processed. We decrement it
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for a callout - still leaving a positive value that identifies the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      assertion. Multiple callouts or any other items will make it zero or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      less, which doesn't matter because they will cause an error later. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      expect_cond_assert = prev_expect_cond_assert - 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If previous_callout is not NULL, it means this follows a previous
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      callout. If it was a manual callout, do nothing; this means its "length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      of next pattern item" field will remain zero. If it was an automatic
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      callout, abolish it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (previous_callout != NULL && (options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          previous_callout == parsed_pattern - 4 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          parsed_pattern[-1] == 255)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        parsed_pattern = previous_callout;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Save for updating next pattern item length, and skip one item before
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      completing. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      previous_callout = parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      after_manual_callout = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle a string argument; specific delimiter is required. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && !IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_SIZE calloutlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_SPTR startptr = ptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        delimiter = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        for (i = 0; PRIV(callout_start_delims)[i] != 0; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (*ptr == PRIV(callout_start_delims)[i])
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            delimiter = PRIV(callout_end_delims)[i];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (delimiter == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR82;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern = META_CALLOUT_STRING;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        parsed_pattern += 3;   /* Skip pattern info */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        for (;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (++ptr >= ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR81;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr = startptr;   /* To give a more useful message */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (*ptr == delimiter && (++ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != delimiter))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        calloutlength = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - startptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (calloutlength > UINT32_MAX)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR72;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = (uint32_t)calloutlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(startptr - cb->start_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle a callout with an optional numerical argument, which must be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      less than or equal to 255. A missing argument gives 0. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int n = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern = META_CALLOUT_NUMBER;     /* Numerical callout */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        parsed_pattern += 3;                       /* Skip pattern info */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        while (ptr < ptrend && IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (n > 255)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR38;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = n;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Both formats must have a closing parenthesis */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR39;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Remember the offset to the next item in the pattern, and set a default
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      length. This should get updated after the next item is read. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      previous_callout[1] = (uint32_t)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      previous_callout[2] = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;                  /* End callout */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Conditional group ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* A condition can be an assertion, a number (referring to a numbered
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      group's having been set), a name (referring to a named group), or 'R',
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      referring to overall recursion. R<digits> and R&name are also permitted
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for recursion state tests. Numbers may be preceded by + or - to specify a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      relative group number.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      There are several syntaxes for testing a named group: (?(name)) is used
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      by Python; Perl 5.10 onwards uses (?(<name>) or (?('name')).
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      There are two unfortunate ambiguities. 'R' can be the recursive thing or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      the name 'R' (and similarly for 'R' followed by digits). 'DEFINE' can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      the Perl DEFINE feature or the Python named test. We look for a name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      first; if not found, we try the other case.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      For compatibility with auto-callouts, we allow a callout to be specified
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      before a condition that is an assertion. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      nest_depth++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the next character is ? or * there must be an assertion next
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      (optionally preceded by a callout). We do not check this here, but
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      instead we set expect_cond_assert to 2. If this is still greater than
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zero (callouts decrement it) when the next assertion is read, it will be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      marked as a condition that must not be repeated. A value greater than
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zero also causes checking that an assertion (possibly with callout)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      follows. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*ptr == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || *ptr == CHAR_ASTERISK)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_ASSERT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr--;   /* Pull pointer back to the opening parenthesis. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        expect_cond_assert = 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;  /* End of conditional */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle (?([+-]number)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (read_number(&ptr, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &i,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &errorcode))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (i <= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR15;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_NUMBER;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 2);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED;   /* Number too big */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* No number found. Handle the special case (?(VERSION[>]=n.m)... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (ptrend - ptr >= 10 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_VERSION, 7) == 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               ptr[7] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint32_t ge = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int major = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int minor = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ptr += 7;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ge = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* NOTE: cannot write IS_DIGIT(*(++ptr)) here because IS_DIGIT
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        references its argument twice. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || (ptr++, !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend, -1, 1000, ERR79, &major, &errorcode))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ptr >= ptrend) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr == CHAR_DOT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (++ptr >= ptrend || !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          minor = (*ptr++ - CHAR_0) * 10;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (ptr >= ptrend) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) minor += *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_VERSION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = ge;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = major;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = minor;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* All the remaining cases now require us to read a name. We cannot at
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      this stage distinguish ambiguous cases such as (?(R12) which might be a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      recursion test by number or a name, because the named groups have not yet
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      all been identified. Those cases are treated as names, but given a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      different META code. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        BOOL was_r_ampersand = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*ptr == CHAR_R && ptrend - ptr > 1 && ptr[1] == CHAR_AMPERSAND)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          was_r_ampersand = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;   /* Point to char before name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Handle (?(R&name) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (was_r_ampersand)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *parsed_pattern = META_COND_RNAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;   /* Back to closing parens */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Handle (?(name). If the name is "DEFINE" we identify it with a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        special code. Likewise if the name consists of R followed only by
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        digits. Otherwise, handle it like a quoted name. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (terminator == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (namelen == 6 && PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, STRING_DEFINE, 6) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern = META_COND_DEFINE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            for (i = 1; i < (int)namelen; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (!IS_DIGIT(name[i])) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *parsed_pattern = (*name == CHAR_R && i >= (int)namelen)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              META_COND_RNUMBER : META_COND_NAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr--;   /* Back to closing parens */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Handle (?('name') or (?(<name>) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else *parsed_pattern = META_COND_NAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* All these cases except DEFINE end with the name length and offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        DEFINE just has an offset (for the "too many branches" error). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*parsed_pattern++ != META_COND_DEFINE) *parsed_pattern++ = namelen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }  /* End cases that read a name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Check the closing parenthesis of the condition */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR24;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* End of condition processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Atomic group ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ATOMIC_GROUP:                          /* Come from (*atomic: */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_ATOMIC;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      nest_depth++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Lookahead assertions ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      POSITIVE_LOOK_AHEAD:                   /* Come from (*pla: */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto POST_ASSERTION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_ASTERISK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      POSITIVE_NONATOMIC_LOOK_AHEAD:         /* Come from (?* */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD_NA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto POST_ASSERTION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      NEGATIVE_LOOK_AHEAD:                   /* Come from (*nla: */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEADNOT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto POST_ASSERTION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Lookbehind assertions ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* (?< followed by = or ! or * is a lookbehind assertion. Otherwise (?<
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      is the start of the name of a capturing group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (ptrend - ptr <= 1 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         (ptr[1] != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr[1] != CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ptr[1] != CHAR_ASTERISK))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto DEFINE_NAME;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = (ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        META_LOOKBEHIND : (ptr[1] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        META_LOOKBEHINDNOT : META_LOOKBEHIND_NA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      POST_LOOKBEHIND:           /* Come from (*plb: (*naplb: and (*nlb: */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *has_lookbehind = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 2);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ptr += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the previous item was a condition starting (?(? an assertion,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      optionally preceded by a callout, is expected. This is checked later on,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      during actual compilation. However we need to identify this kind of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      assertion in this pass because it must not be qualified. The value of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      expect_cond_assert is set to 2 after (?(? is processed. We decrement it
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for a callout - still leaving a positive value that identifies the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      assertion. Multiple callouts or any other items will make it zero or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      less, which doesn't matter because they will cause an error later. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      POST_ASSERTION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      nest_depth++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (prev_expect_cond_assert > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (++top_nest >= end_nests)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR84;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->flags = NSF_CONDASSERT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* ---- Define a named group ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* A named group may be defined as (?'name') or (?<name>). In the latter
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case we jump to DEFINE_NAME from the disambiguation of (?< above with the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      terminator set to '>'. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case CHAR_APOSTROPHE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE;    /* Terminator */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      DEFINE_NAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* We have a name for this capturing group. It is also assigned a number,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      which is its primary means of identification. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (cb->bracount >= MAX_GROUP_NUMBER)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR97;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->bracount++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *parsed_pattern++ = META_CAPTURE | cb->bracount;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      nest_depth++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Check not too many names */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (cb->names_found >= MAX_NAME_COUNT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        errorcode = ERR49;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Adjust the entry size to accommodate the longest name found. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1 > cb->name_entry_size)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cb->name_entry_size = (uint16_t)(namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Scan the list to check for duplicates. For duplicate names, if the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      number is the same, break the loop, which causes the name to be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      discarded; otherwise, if DUPNAMES is not set, give an error.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      If it is set, allow the name with a different number, but continue
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      scanning in case this is a duplicate with the same number. For
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      non-duplicate names, give an error if the number is duplicated. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      isdupname = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ng = cb->named_groups;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (namelen == ng->length &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, (PCRE2_SIZE)namelen) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (ng->number == cb->bracount) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if ((options & PCRE2_DUPNAMES) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR43;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          isdupname = ng->isdup = TRUE;     /* Mark as a duplicate */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->dupnames = TRUE;              /* Duplicate names exist */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (ng->number == cb->bracount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR65;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (i < cb->names_found) break;   /* Ignore duplicate with same number */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Increase the list size if necessary */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (cb->names_found >= cb->named_group_list_size)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint32_t newsize = cb->named_group_list_size * 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        named_group *newspace =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->cx->memctl.malloc(newsize * sizeof(named_group),
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->cx->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (newspace == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR21;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        memcpy(newspace, cb->named_groups,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->named_group_list_size * sizeof(named_group));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (cb->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->cx->memctl.free((void *)cb->named_groups,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->cx->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cb->named_groups = newspace;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cb->named_group_list_size = newsize;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Add this name to the list */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].name = name;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].length = (uint16_t)namelen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].number = cb->bracount;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].isdup = (uint16_t)isdupname;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->names_found++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }        /* End of (? switch */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;     /* End of ( handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ---- Branch terminators ---- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Alternation: reset the capture count if we are in a (?| group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (top_nest != NULL && top_nest->nest_depth == nest_depth &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (top_nest->flags & NSF_RESET) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (cb->bracount > top_nest->max_group)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        top_nest->max_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->bracount = top_nest->reset_group;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = META_ALT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* End of group; reset the capture count to the maximum if we are in a (?|
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group and/or reset the options that are tracked during parsing. Disallow
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    quantifier for a condition that is an assertion. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    okquantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (top_nest != NULL && top_nest->nest_depth == nest_depth)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      options = (options & ~PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS) | top_nest->options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_RESET) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          top_nest->max_group > cb->bracount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cb->bracount = top_nest->max_group;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_CONDASSERT) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        okquantifier = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_ATOMICSR) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (top_nest == (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace)) top_nest = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else top_nest--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (nest_depth == 0)    /* Unmatched closing parenthesis */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      errorcode = ERR22;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto FAILED_BACK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    nest_depth--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }  /* End of switch on pattern character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }    /* End of main character scan loop */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* End of pattern reached. Check for missing ) at the end of a verb name. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (inverbname && ptr >= ptrend)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = ERR60;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Manage callout for the final item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PARSED_END:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(ptr, &previous_callout, auto_callout,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_pattern, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Insert trailing items for word and line matching (features provided for the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								benefit of pcre2grep). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_DOLLAR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Terminate the parsed pattern, then return success if all groups are closed.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Otherwise we have unclosed parentheses. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = ERR63;  /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*parsed_pattern = META_END;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (nest_depth == 0) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								errorcode = ERR14;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Come here for all failures. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								FAILED:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb->erroroffset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return errorcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Some errors need to indicate the previous character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								FAILED_BACK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ptr--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This failure happens several times. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BAD_VERSION_CONDITION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								errorcode = ERR79;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								goto FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*       Find first significant opcode            *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is called by several functions that scan a compiled expression looking
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for a fixed first character, or an anchoring opcode etc. It skips over things
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								that do not influence this. For some calls, it makes sense to skip negative
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								forward and all backward assertions, and also the \b assertion; for others it
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								does not.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code         pointer to the start of the group
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  skipassert   TRUE if certain assertions are to be skipped
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:       pointer to the first significant opcode
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static const PCRE2_UCHAR*
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								first_significant_code(PCRE2_SPTR code, BOOL skipassert)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  switch ((int)*code)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_ASSERTBACK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!skipassert) return code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!skipassert) return code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_CALLOUT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_CREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_DNCREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_RREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_DNRREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_FALSE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_TRUE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_CALLOUT_STR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += GET(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_SKIPZERO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += 2 + GET(code, 2) + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_COND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_SCOND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (code[1+LINK_SIZE] != OP_FALSE ||   /* Not DEFINE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code[GET(code, 1)] != OP_KET)      /* More than one branch */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += GET(code, 1) + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_COMMIT_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case OP_THEN_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += code[1] + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Control never reaches here */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*           Get othercase range                  *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is passed the start and end of a class range in UCP mode. It
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								searches up the characters, looking for ranges of characters in the "other"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								case. Each call returns the next one, updating the start address. A character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								with multiple other cases is returned on its own with a special return value.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cptr        points to starting character value; updated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  d           end value
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ocptr       where to put start of othercase range
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  odptr       where to put end of othercase range
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Yield:        -1 when no more
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               0 when a range is returned
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              >0 the CASESET offset for char with multiple other cases
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                in this case, ocptr contains the original
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								get_othercase_range(uint32_t *cptr, uint32_t d, uint32_t *ocptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t *odptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t c, othercase, next;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unsigned int co;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Find the first character that has an other case. If it has multiple other
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cases, return its case offset value. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (c = *cptr; c <= d; c++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *ocptr = c++;   /* Character that has the set */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *cptr = c;      /* Rest of input range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return (int)co;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((othercase = UCD_OTHERCASE(c)) != c) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (c > d) return -1;  /* Reached end of range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Found a character that has a single other case. Search for the end of the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								range, which is either the end of the input range, or a character that has zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								or more than one other cases. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*ocptr = othercase;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								next = othercase + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (++c; c <= d; c++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0 || UCD_OTHERCASE(c) != next) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  next++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*odptr = next - 1;     /* End of othercase range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*cptr = c;             /* Rest of input range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								* Add a character or range to a class (internal) *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function packages up the logic of adding a character or range of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								characters to a class. The character values in the arguments will be within the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								valid values for the current mode (8-bit, 16-bit, UTF, etc). This function is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								called only from within the "add to class" group of functions, some of which
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								are recursive and mutually recursive. The external entry point is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_to_class().
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options       the options word
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb            compile data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  start         start of range character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  end           end of range character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                the pointer to extra data is updated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_to_class_internal(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, uint32_t start, uint32_t end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unsigned int n8 = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If caseless matching is required, scan the range and process alternate
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cases. In Unicode, there are 8-bit characters that have alternate cases that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								are greater than 255 and vice-versa. Sometimes we can just extend the original
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								range. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((options & (PCRE2_UTF|PCRE2_UCP)) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    int rc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    uint32_t oc, od;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    options &= ~PCRE2_CASELESS;   /* Remove for recursive calls */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    c = start;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while ((rc = get_othercase_range(&c, end, &oc, &od)) >= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle a single character that has more than one other case. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (rc > 0) n8 += add_list_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + rc, oc);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Do nothing if the other case range is within the original range. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (oc >= cb->class_range_start && od <= cb->class_range_end) continue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Extend the original range if there is overlap, noting that if oc < c, we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      can't have od > end because a subrange is always shorter than the basic
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      range. Otherwise, use a recursive call to add the additional range. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (oc < start && od >= start - 1) start = oc; /* Extend downwards */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (od > end && oc <= end + 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        end = od;       /* Extend upwards */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (end > classbits_end) classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, oc, od);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Not UTF mode */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    SETBIT(classbits, cb->fcc[c]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    n8++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Now handle the originally supplied range. Adjust the final value according
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								to the bit length - this means that the same lists of (e.g.) horizontal spaces
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								can be used in all cases. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 && end > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  end = MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (start > cb->class_range_start && end < cb->class_range_end) return n8;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Use the bitmap for characters < 256. Otherwise use extra data.*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Regardless of start, c will always be <= 255. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  SETBIT(classbits, c);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  n8++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (start <= 0xff) start = 0xff + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (end >= start)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_UCHAR *uchardata = *uchardptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (start < end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(end, uchardata);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else if (start == end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Without UTF support, character values are constrained by the bit length,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  and can only be > 256 for 16-bit and 32-bit libraries. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (start < end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *uchardata++ = start;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *uchardata++ = end;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if (start == end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *uchardata++ = start;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *uchardptr = uchardata;   /* Updata extra data pointer */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else  /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  (void)uchardptr;          /* Avoid compiler warning */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return n8;    /* Number of 8-bit characters */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								* Add a list of characters to a class (internal) *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is used for adding a list of case-equivalent characters to a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								class when in UTF mode. This function is called only from within
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_to_class_internal(), with which it is mutually recursive.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options       the options word
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb            contains pointers to tables etc.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  except        character to omit; this is used when adding lists of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  already know about
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                the pointer to extra data is updated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_list_to_class_internal(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p, unsigned int except)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unsigned int n8 = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  unsigned int n = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (p[0] != except)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0], p[n]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p += n + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return n8;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*   External entry point for add range to class  *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function sets the overall range so that the internal functions can try
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								to avoid duplication when handling case-independence.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options       the options word
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb            compile data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  start         start of range character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  end           end of range character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                the pointer to extra data is updated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, uint32_t options,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  compile_block *cb, uint32_t start, uint32_t end)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb->class_range_start = start;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb->class_range_end = end;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, start, end);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*   External entry point for add list to class   *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is used for adding a list of horizontal or vertical whitespace
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								characters to a class. The list must be in order so that ranges of characters
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								can be detected and handled appropriately. This function sets the overall range
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								so that the internal functions can try to avoid duplication when handling
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								case-independence.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options       the options word
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb            contains pointers to tables etc.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  except        character to omit; this is used when adding lists of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  already know about
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                the pointer to extra data is updated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_list_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, uint32_t options,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p, unsigned int except)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unsigned int n8 = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  unsigned int n = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (p[0] != except)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->class_range_start = p[0];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->class_range_end = p[n];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0], p[n]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p += n + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return n8;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*    Add characters not in a list to a class     *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is used for adding the complement of a list of horizontal or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								vertical whitespace to a class. The list must be in order.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options       the options word
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb            contains pointers to tables etc.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                the pointer to extra data is updated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static unsigned int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_not_list_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unsigned int n8 = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (p[0] > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, 0, p[0] - 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  while (p[1] == p[0] + 1) p++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0] + 1,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (p[1] == NOTACHAR) ? (utf ? 0x10ffffu : 0xffffffffu) : p[1] - 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  p++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return n8;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*    Find details of duplicate group names       *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is called from compile_branch() when it needs to know the index and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								count of duplicates in the names table when processing named backreferences,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								either directly, or as conditions.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  name          points to the name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  length        the length of the name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  indexptr      where to put the index
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  countptr      where to put the count of duplicates
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcodeptr  where to put an error code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb            the compile block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:        TRUE if OK, FALSE if not, error code set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								find_dupname_details(PCRE2_SPTR name, uint32_t length, int *indexptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int *countptr, int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t i, groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int count;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *slot = cb->name_table;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Find the first entry in the table */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (PRIV(strncmp)(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, length) == 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] == 0) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  slot += cb->name_entry_size;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This should not occur, because this function is called only when we know we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								have duplicate names. Give an internal error. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (i >= cb->names_found)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorcodeptr = ERR53;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb->erroroffset = name - cb->start_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Record the index and then see how many duplicates there are, updating the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								backref map and maximum back reference as we do. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*indexptr = i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								count = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  count++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  groupnumber = GET2(slot,0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb->backref_map |= (groupnumber < 32)? (1u << groupnumber) : 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (++i >= cb->names_found) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  slot += cb->name_entry_size;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (PRIV(strncmp)(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, length) != 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (slot+IMM2_SIZE)[length] != 0) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*countptr = count;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*           Compile one branch                   *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Scan the parsed pattern, compiling it into the a vector of PCRE2_UCHAR. If
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the options are changed during the branch, the pointer is used to change the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								external options bits. This function is used during the pre-compile phase when
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								we are trying to find out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								real compile phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  optionsptr        pointer to the option bits
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  codeptr           points to the pointer to the current code point
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptrptr           points to the current parsed pattern pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcodeptr      points to error code variable
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  firstcuptr        place to put the first required code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  firstcuflagsptr   place to put the first code unit flags
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reqcuptr          place to put the last required code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reqcuflagsptr     place to put the last required code unit flags
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  bcptr             points to current branch chain
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb                contains pointers to tables etc.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:            0 There's been an error, *errorcodeptr is non-zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   +1 Success, this branch must match at least one character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   -1 Success, this branch may match an empty string
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compile_branch(uint32_t *optionsptr, PCRE2_UCHAR **codeptr, uint32_t **pptrptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t *firstcuptr, uint32_t *firstcuflagsptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t *reqcuptr, uint32_t *reqcuflagsptr, branch_chain *bcptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SIZE *lengthptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int bravalue = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int okreturn = -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int group_return = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t repeat_min = 0, repeat_max = 0;      /* To please picky compilers */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t greedy_default, greedy_non_default;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t repeat_type, op_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t options = *optionsptr;               /* May change dynamically */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t firstcu, reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t zeroreqcu, zerofirstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t meta, meta_arg;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t zeroreqcuflags, zerofirstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t req_caseopt, reqvary, tempreqvary;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE offset = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE length_prevgroup = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *code = *codeptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *last_code = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *orig_code = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *tempcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *previous = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR op_previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL groupsetfirstcu = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL had_accept = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL matched_char = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL previous_matched_char = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL reset_caseful = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								const uint8_t *cbits = cb->cbits;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint8_t classbits[32];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* We can fish out the UTF setting once and for all into a BOOL, but we must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								not do this for other options (e.g. PCRE2_EXTENDED) because they may change
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								dynamically as we process the pattern. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL ucp = (options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else  /* No Unicode support */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL utf = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Helper variables for OP_XCLASS opcode (for characters > 255). We define
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								class_uchardata always so that it can be passed to add_to_class() always,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								though it will not be used in non-UTF 8-bit cases. This avoids having to supply
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								alternative calls for the different cases. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *class_uchardata;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL xclass;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *class_uchardata_base;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Set up the default and non-default settings for greediness */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								greedy_default = ((options & PCRE2_UNGREEDY) != 0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Initialize no first unit, no required unit. REQ_UNSET means "no char
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								matching encountered yet". It gets changed to REQ_NONE if we hit something that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								matches a non-fixed first unit; reqcu just remains unset if we never find one.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								When we hit a repeat whose minimum is zero, we may have to adjust these values
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								to take the zero repeat into account. This is implemented by setting them to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								zerofirstcu and zeroreqcu when such a repeat is encountered. The individual
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								item types that can be repeated set these backoff variables appropriately. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								firstcu = reqcu = zerofirstcu = zeroreqcu = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								firstcuflags = reqcuflags = zerofirstcuflags = zeroreqcuflags = REQ_UNSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The variable req_caseopt contains either the REQ_CASELESS bit or zero,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								according to the current setting of the caseless flag. The REQ_CASELESS value
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								leaves the lower 28 bit empty. It is added into the firstcu or reqcu variables
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								to record the case status of the value. This is used only for ASCII characters.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS : 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Switch on next META item until the end of the branch */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;; pptr++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL xclass_has_prop;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL negate_class;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL should_flip_negation;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL match_all_or_no_wide_chars;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL possessive_quantifier;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  BOOL note_group_empty;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int class_has_8bitchar;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t mclength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t skipunits;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t subreqcu, subfirstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t verbarglen, verbculen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t subreqcuflags, subfirstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  open_capitem *oc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_UCHAR mcbuffer[8];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Get next META item in the pattern and its potential argument. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  meta = META_CODE(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  meta_arg = META_DATA(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If we are in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length used for the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  previous cycle of this loop, unless the next item is a quantifier. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (code > cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size -
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)                       /* Check for overrun */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = (code >= cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size)?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ERR52 : ERR86;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* There is at least one situation where code goes backwards: this is the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case of a zero quantifier after a class (e.g. [ab]{0}). When the quantifier
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    is processed, the whole class is eliminated. However, it is created first,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    so we have to allow memory for it. Therefore, don't ever reduce the length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    at this point. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (code < last_code) code = last_code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If the next thing is not a quantifier, we add the length of the previous
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    item into the total, and reset the code pointer to the start of the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    workspace. Otherwise leave the previous item available to be quantified. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta < META_ASTERISK || meta > META_MINMAX_QUERY)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < (PCRE2_SIZE)(code - orig_code))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;   /* Integer overflow */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *lengthptr += (PCRE2_SIZE)(code - orig_code);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*lengthptr > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;   /* Pattern is too large */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code = orig_code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Remember where this code item starts so we can catch the "backwards"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case above next time round. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    last_code = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Process the next parsed pattern item. If it is not a quantifier, remember
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  where it starts so that it can be quantified when a quantifier follows.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  Checking for the legality of quantifiers happens in parse_regex(), except for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  a quantifier after an assertion that is a condition. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (meta < META_ASTERISK || meta > META_MINMAX_QUERY)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    previous = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (matched_char && !had_accept) okreturn = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  previous_matched_char = matched_char;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  matched_char = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  note_group_empty = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  skipunits = 0;         /* Default value for most subgroups */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  switch(meta)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The branch terminates at pattern end or | or ) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_END:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ALT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_KET:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *firstcuptr = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *firstcuflagsptr = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *reqcuptr = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *reqcuflagsptr = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *codeptr = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *pptrptr = pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return okreturn;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle single-character metacharacters. In multiline mode, ^ disables
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the setting of any following char as a first character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CIRCUMFLEX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((options & PCRE2_MULTILINE) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *code++ = OP_CIRCM;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else *code++ = OP_CIRC;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOLLAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_MULTILINE) != 0)? OP_DOLLM : OP_DOLL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* There can never be a first char if '.' is first, whatever happens about
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeats. The value of reqcu doesn't change either. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcu = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_DOTALL) != 0)? OP_ALLANY: OP_ANY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Empty character classes are allowed if PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS is set.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Otherwise, an initial ']' is taken as a data character. When empty classes
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    are allowed, [] must always fail, so generate OP_FAIL, whereas [^] must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    match any character, so generate OP_ALLANY. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_EMPTY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = (meta == META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT)? OP_ALLANY : OP_FAIL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Non-empty character class. If the included characters are all < 256, we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    build a 32-byte bitmap of the permitted characters, except in the special
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case where there is only one such character. For negated classes, we build
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the map as usual, then invert it at the end. However, we use a different
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    opcode so that data characters > 255 can be handled correctly.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    If the class contains characters outside the 0-255 range, a different
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    opcode is compiled. It may optionally have a bit map for characters < 256,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    but those above are are explicitly listed afterwards. A flag code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    tells whether the bitmap is present, and whether this is a negated class or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    not. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    negate_class = meta == META_CLASS_NOT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* We can optimize the case of a single character in a class by generating
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    OP_CHAR or OP_CHARI if it's positive, or OP_NOT or OP_NOTI if it's
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    negative. In the negative case there can be no first char if this item is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    first, whatever repeat count may follow. In the case of reqcu, save the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    previous value for reinstating. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* NOTE: at present this optimization is not effective if the only
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character in a class in 32-bit, non-UCP mode has its top bit set. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (pptr[1] < META_END && pptr[2] == META_CLASS_END)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t d;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t c = pptr[1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 2;                 /* Move on to class end */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (meta == META_CLASS)    /* A positive one-char class can be */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {                        /* handled as a normal literal character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        meta = c;                /* Set up the character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto NORMAL_CHAR_SET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle a negative one-character class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zeroreqcu = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* For caseless UTF or UCP mode, check whether this character has more
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      than one other case. If so, generate a special OP_NOTPROP item instead of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      OP_NOTI. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((utf||ucp) && (options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (d = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_NOTPROP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = PT_CLIST;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = d;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;   /* We are finished with this class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Char has only one other case, or UCP not available */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_NOTI: OP_NOT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code += PUTCHAR(c, code);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;   /* We are finished with this class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }        /* End of 1-char optimization */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle character classes that contain more than just one literal
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character. If there are exactly two characters in a positive class, see if
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    they are case partners. This can be optimized to generate a caseless single
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character match (which also sets first/required code units if relevant). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta == META_CLASS && pptr[1] < META_END && pptr[2] < META_END &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        pptr[3] == META_CLASS_END)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t c = pptr[1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (UCD_CASESET(c) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint32_t d;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((utf || ucp) && c > 127) d = UCD_OTHERCASE(c); else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH != 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (c > 255) d = c; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          d = TABLE_GET(c, cb->fcc, c);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c != d && pptr[2] == d)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          pptr += 3;                 /* Move on to class end */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          meta = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            reset_caseful = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            options |= PCRE2_CASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            req_caseopt = REQ_CASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CLASS_CASELESS_CHAR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If a non-extended class contains a negative special such as \S, we need
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    to flip the negation flag at the end, so that support for characters > 255
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    works correctly (they are all included in the class). An extended class may
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    need to insert specific matching or non-matching code for wide characters.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    should_flip_negation = match_all_or_no_wide_chars = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Extended class (xclass) will be used when characters > 255
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    might match. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    xclass = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    class_uchardata = code + LINK_SIZE + 2;   /* For XCLASS items */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    class_uchardata_base = class_uchardata;   /* Save the start */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* For optimization purposes, we track some properties of the class:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    class_has_8bitchar will be non-zero if the class contains at least one
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character with a code point less than 256; xclass_has_prop will be TRUE if
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Unicode property checks are present in the class. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    class_has_8bitchar = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    xclass_has_prop = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Initialize the 256-bit (32-byte) bit map to all zeros. We build the map
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in a temporary bit of memory, in case the class contains fewer than two
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    8-bit characters because in that case the compiled code doesn't use the bit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    map. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    memset(classbits, 0, 32 * sizeof(uint8_t));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Process items until META_CLASS_END is reached. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    while ((meta = *(++pptr)) != META_CLASS_END)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle POSIX classes such as [:alpha:] etc. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (meta == META_POSIX || meta == META_POSIX_NEG)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        BOOL local_negate = (meta == META_POSIX_NEG);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int posix_class = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int taboffset, tabopt;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint8_t pbits[32];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        should_flip_negation = local_negate;  /* Note negative special */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If matching is caseless, upper and lower are converted to alpha.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        This relies on the fact that the class table starts with alpha,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        lower, upper as the first 3 entries. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0 && posix_class <= 2)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          posix_class = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* When PCRE2_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        different escape sequences that use Unicode properties \p or \P.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        Others that are not available via \p or \P have to generate
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        XCL_PROP/XCL_NOTPROP directly, which is done here. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0) switch(posix_class)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PC_GRAPH:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PC_PRINT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PC_PUNCT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *class_uchardata++ = local_negate? XCL_NOTPROP : XCL_PROP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *class_uchardata++ = (PCRE2_UCHAR)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ((posix_class == PC_GRAPH)? PT_PXGRAPH :
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             (posix_class == PC_PRINT)? PT_PXPRINT : PT_PXPUNCT);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *class_uchardata++ = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CONTINUE_CLASS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* For the other POSIX classes (ascii, xdigit) we are going to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          fall through to the non-UCP case and build a bit map for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          characters with code points less than 256. However, if we are in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          a negated POSIX class, characters with code points greater than
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          255 must either all match or all not match, depending on whether
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          the whole class is not or is negated. For example, for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          [[:^ascii:]... they must all match, whereas for [^[:^xdigit:]...
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          they must not.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          In the special case where there are no xclass items, this is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          automatically handled by the use of OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, but an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          explicit range is needed for OP_XCLASS. Setting a flag here
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          causes the range to be generated later when it is known that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          OP_XCLASS is required. In the 8-bit library this is relevant only in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          utf mode, since no wide characters can exist otherwise. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (utf)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          match_all_or_no_wide_chars |= local_negate;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* In the non-UCP case, or when UCP makes no difference, we build the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        bit map for the POSIX class in a chunk of local store because we may
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        be adding and subtracting from it, and we don't want to subtract bits
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        that may be in the main map already. At the end we or the result into
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        the bit map that is being built. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        posix_class *= 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Copy in the first table (always present) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        memcpy(pbits, cbits + posix_class_maps[posix_class],
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          32 * sizeof(uint8_t));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If there is a second table, add or remove it as required. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        taboffset = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        tabopt = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 2];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (taboffset >= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (tabopt >= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) pbits[i] |= cbits[(int)i + taboffset];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) pbits[i] &= ~cbits[(int)i + taboffset];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Now see if we need to remove any special characters. An option
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        value of 1 removes vertical space and 2 removes underscore. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (tabopt < 0) tabopt = -tabopt;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (tabopt == 1) pbits[1] &= ~0x3c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else if (tabopt == 2) pbits[11] &= 0x7f;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Add the POSIX table or its complement into the main table that is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        being built and we are done. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (local_negate)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~pbits[i]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= pbits[i];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        class_has_8bitchar = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto CONTINUE_CLASS;    /* End of POSIX handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Other than POSIX classes, the only items we should encounter are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \d-type escapes and literal characters (possibly as ranges). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (meta == META_BIGVALUE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        meta = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto CLASS_LITERAL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Any other non-literal must be an escape */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (meta >= META_END)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (META_CODE(meta) != META_ESCAPE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          fprintf(stderr, "** Unrecognized parsed pattern item 0x%.8x "
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                          "in character class\n", meta);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR89;  /* Internal error - unrecognized. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        escape = META_DATA(meta);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        class_has_8bitchar++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        switch(escape)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_d:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_digit];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_D:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          should_flip_negation = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_digit]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_w:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_word];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_W:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          should_flip_negation = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_word]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Perl 5.004 onwards omitted VT from \s, but restored it at Perl
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          5.18. Before PCRE 8.34, we had to preserve the VT bit if it was
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          previously set by something earlier in the character class.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          Luckily, the value of CHAR_VT is 0x0b in both ASCII and EBCDIC, so
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          we could just adjust the appropriate bit. From PCRE 8.34 we no
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          longer treat \s and \S specially. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_s:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_space];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_S:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          should_flip_negation = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_space]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* When adding the horizontal or vertical space lists to a class, or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          their complements, disable PCRE2_CASELESS, because it justs wastes
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          time, and in the "not-x" UTF cases can create unwanted duplicates in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          the XCLASS list (provoked by characters that have more than one other
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case and by both cases being in the same "not-x" sublist). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_h:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(hspace_list), NOTACHAR);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_H:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(hspace_list));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_v:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(vspace_list), NOTACHAR);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_V:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(vspace_list));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* If Unicode is not supported, \P and \p are not allowed and are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          faulted at parse time, so will never appear here. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_p:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case ESC_P:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            uint32_t ptype = *(++pptr) >> 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            uint32_t pdata = *pptr & 0xffff;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *class_uchardata++ = (escape == ESC_p)? XCL_PROP : XCL_NOTPROP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *class_uchardata++ = ptype;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *class_uchardata++ = pdata;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            class_has_8bitchar--;                /* Undo! */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto CONTINUE_CLASS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }  /* End handling \d-type escapes */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* A literal character may be followed by a range meta. At parse time
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      there are checks for out-of-order characters, for ranges where the two
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      characters are equal, and for hyphens that cannot indicate a range. At
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      this point, therefore, no checking is needed. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        uint32_t c, d;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        CLASS_LITERAL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        c = d = meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Remember if \r or \n were explicitly used */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (c == CHAR_CR || c == CHAR_NL) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Process a character range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (pptr[1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL || pptr[1] == META_RANGE_ESCAPED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          BOOL range_is_literal = (pptr[1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          pptr += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          d = *pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (d == META_BIGVALUE) d = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Remember an explicit \r or \n, and add the range to the class. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (d == CHAR_CR || d == CHAR_NL) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* In an EBCDIC environment, Perl treats alphabetic ranges specially
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          because there are holes in the encoding, and simply using the range
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          A-Z (for example) would include the characters in the holes. This
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          applies only to literal ranges; [\xC1-\xE9] is different to [A-Z]. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef EBCDIC
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (range_is_literal &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_letter) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               (cb->ctypes[d] & ctype_letter) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               (c <= CHAR_z) == (d <= CHAR_z))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            uint32_t uc = (d <= CHAR_z)? 0 : 64;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            uint32_t C = c - uc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            uint32_t D = d - uc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (C <= CHAR_i)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              class_has_8bitchar +=
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  ((D < CHAR_i)? D : CHAR_i) + uc);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              C = CHAR_j;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (C <= D && C <= CHAR_r)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              class_has_8bitchar +=
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  ((D < CHAR_r)? D : CHAR_r) + uc);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              C = CHAR_s;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (C <= D)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              class_has_8bitchar +=
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  D + uc);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Not an EBCDIC special range */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          class_has_8bitchar +=
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, c, d);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto CONTINUE_CLASS;   /* Go get the next char in the class */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }  /* End of range handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Handle a single character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        class_has_8bitchar +=
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, meta, meta);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Continue to the next item in the class. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      CONTINUE_CLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If any wide characters or Unicode properties have been encountered,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      set xclass = TRUE. Then, in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      of the extra data and reset the pointer. This is so that very large
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      classes that contain a zillion wide characters or Unicode property tests
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      do not overwrite the workspace (which is on the stack). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        xclass = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *lengthptr += class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          class_uchardata = class_uchardata_base;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      continue;  /* Needed to avoid error when not supporting wide chars */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }   /* End of main class-processing loop */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If this class is the first thing in the branch, there can be no first
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    char setting, whatever the repeat count. Any reqcu setting must remain
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    unchanged after any kind of repeat. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcu = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If there are characters with values > 255, or Unicode property settings
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (\p or \P), we have to compile an extended class, with its own opcode,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    unless there were no property settings and there was a negated special such
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    as \S in the class, and PCRE2_UCP is not set, because in that case all
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    characters > 255 are in or not in the class, so any that were explicitly
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    given as well can be ignored.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    In the UCP case, if certain negated POSIX classes ([:^ascii:] or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    [^:xdigit:]) were present in a class, we either have to match or not match
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    all wide characters (depending on whether the whole class is or is not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    negated). This requirement is indicated by match_all_or_no_wide_chars being
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    true. We do this by including an explicit range, which works in both cases.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    This applies only in UTF and 16-bit and 32-bit non-UTF modes, since there
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cannot be any wide characters in 8-bit non-UTF mode.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    When there *are* properties in a positive UTF-8 or any 16-bit or 32_bit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    class where \S etc is present without PCRE2_UCP, causing an extended class
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    to be compiled, we make sure that all characters > 255 are included by
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    forcing match_all_or_no_wide_chars to be true.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    If, when generating an xclass, there are no characters < 256, we can omit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the bitmap in the actual compiled code. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS  /* Defined for 16/32 bits, or 8-bit with Unicode */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (xclass && (
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (match_all_or_no_wide_chars || (
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								           utf &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								           should_flip_negation && !negate_class && (options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (utf)   /* Will always be utf in the 8-bit library */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT, class_uchardata);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else       /* Can only happen for the 16-bit & 32-bit libraries */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffffffu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *class_uchardata++ = XCL_END;    /* Marks the end of extra data */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *code++ = OP_XCLASS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code += LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *code = negate_class? XCL_NOT:0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (xclass_has_prop) *code |= XCL_HASPROP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the map is required, move up the extra data to make room for it;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      otherwise just move the code pointer to the end of the extra data. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (class_has_8bitchar > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ |= XCL_MAP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (void)memmove(code + (32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)), code,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          CU2BYTES(class_uchardata - code));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (negate_class && !xclass_has_prop)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Using 255 ^ instead of ~ avoids clang sanitize warning. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] = 255 ^ classbits[i];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code = class_uchardata + (32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else code = class_uchardata;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Now fill in the complete length of the item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT(previous, 1, (int)(code - previous));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;   /* End of class handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If there are no characters > 255, or they are all to be included or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    excluded, set the opcode to OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, depending on whether the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    whole class was negated and whether there were negative specials such as \S
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (non-UCP) in the class. Then copy the 32-byte map into the code vector,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    negating it if necessary. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = (negate_class == should_flip_negation) ? OP_CLASS : OP_NCLASS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (lengthptr == NULL)    /* Save time in the pre-compile phase */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (negate_class)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       /* Using 255 ^ instead of ~ avoids clang sanitize warning. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] = 255 ^ classbits[i];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += 32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;  /* End of class processing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Deal with (*VERB)s. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Check for open captures before ACCEPT and close those that are within
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the same assertion level, also converting ACCEPT to ASSERT_ACCEPT in an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    assertion. In the first pass, just accumulate the length required;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    otherwise hitting (*ACCEPT) inside many nested parentheses can cause
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    workspace overflow. Do not set firstcu after *ACCEPT. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ACCEPT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->had_accept = had_accept = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for (oc = cb->open_caps;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         oc != NULL && oc->assert_depth >= cb->assert_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         oc = oc->next)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *lengthptr += CU2BYTES(1) + IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_CLOSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUT2INC(code, 0, oc->number);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = (cb->assert_depth > 0)? OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT : OP_ACCEPT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->had_pruneorskip = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_FAIL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = verbops[(meta - META_MARK) >> 16];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASTHEN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = OP_THEN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle verbs with arguments. Arguments can be very long, especially in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    16- and 32-bit modes, and can overflow the workspace in the first pass.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    However, the argument length is constrained to be small enough to fit in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    one code unit. This check happens in parse_regex(). In the first pass,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    instead of putting the argument into memory, we just update the length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    counter and set up an empty argument. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASTHEN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto VERB_ARG;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->had_pruneorskip = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    VERB_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = verbops[(meta - META_MARK) >> 16];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The length is in characters. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    verbarglen = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    verbculen = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    tempcode = code++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for (int i = 0; i < (int)verbarglen; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      meta = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (utf) mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(meta, mcbuffer); else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        mclength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        mcbuffer[0] = meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (lengthptr != NULL) *lengthptr += mclength; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code += mclength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        verbculen += mclength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *tempcode = verbculen;   /* Fill in the code unit length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = 0;             /* Terminating zero */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle options change. The new setting must be passed back for use in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    subsequent branches. Reset the greedy defaults and the case value for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    firstcu and reqcu. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_OPTIONS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *optionsptr = options = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    greedy_default = ((options & PCRE2_UNGREEDY) != 0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS : 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle conditional subpatterns. The case of (?(Rdigits) is ambiguous
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    because it could be a numerical check on recursion, or a name check on a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group's being set. The pre-pass sets up META_COND_RNUMBER as a name so that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    we can handle it either way. We first try for a name; if not found, process
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the number. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNUMBER:   /* (?(Rdigits) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NAME:      /* (?(name) or (?'name') or ?(<name>) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNAME:     /* (?(R&name) - test for recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_COND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      int count, index;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      unsigned int i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SPTR name;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      named_group *ng = cb->named_groups;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t length = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      name = cb->start_pattern + offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* In the first pass, the names generated in the pre-pass are available,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      but the main name table has not yet been created. Scan the list of names
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      generated in the pre-pass in order to get a number and whether or not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      this name is duplicated. If it is not duplicated, we can handle it as a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      numerical group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (length == ng->length &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (!ng->isdup)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (meta == META_COND_RNAME)? OP_RREF : OP_CREF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, ng->number);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (ng->number > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = ng->number;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;  /* Found a duplicated name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the name was not found we have a bad reference, unless we are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      dealing with R<digits>, which is treated as a recursion test by number.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (i >= cb->names_found)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        groupnumber = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (meta == META_COND_RNUMBER)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          for (i = 1; i < length; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            groupnumber = groupnumber * 10 + name[i] - CHAR_0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (groupnumber > MAX_GROUP_NUMBER)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              cb->erroroffset = offset + i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (meta != META_COND_RNUMBER || groupnumber > cb->bracount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* (?Rdigits) treated as a recursion reference by number. A value of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        zero (which is the result of both (?R) and (?R0)) means "any", and is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        translated into RREF_ANY (which is 0xffff). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (groupnumber == 0) groupnumber = RREF_ANY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, groupnumber);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* A duplicated name was found. Note that if an R<digits> name is found
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      (META_COND_RNUMBER), it is a reference test, not a recursion test. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (meta == META_COND_RNAME)? OP_RREF : OP_CREF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* We have a duplicated name. In the compile pass we have to search the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      main table in order to get the index and count values. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      count = 0;  /* Values for first pass (avoids compiler warning) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      index = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (lengthptr == NULL && !find_dupname_details(name, length, &index,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            &count, errorcodeptr, cb)) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Add one to the opcode to change CREF/RREF into DNCREF/DNRREF and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      insert appropriate data values. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code[1+LINK_SIZE]++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      skipunits = 1+2*IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, index);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE+IMM2_SIZE, count);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The DEFINE condition is always false. Its internal groups may never
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    be called, so matched_char must remain false, hence the jump to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GROUP_PROCESS rather than GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_DEFINE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_COND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_DEFINE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    skipunits = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Conditional test of a group's being set. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_COND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    groupnumber = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (groupnumber > cb->bracount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    offset -= 2;   /* Point at initial ( for too many branches error */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_CREF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, groupnumber);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Test for the PCRE2 version. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_VERSION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_COND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (pptr[1] > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code[1+LINK_SIZE] = ((PCRE2_MAJOR > pptr[2]) ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (PCRE2_MAJOR == pptr[2] && PCRE2_MINOR >= pptr[3]))?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          OP_TRUE : OP_FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (PCRE2_MAJOR == pptr[2] && PCRE2_MINOR == pptr[3])?
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        OP_TRUE : OP_FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    skipunits = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The condition is an assertion, possibly preceded by a callout. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_ASSERT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_COND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle all kinds of nested bracketed groups. The non-capturing,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    non-conditional cases are here; others come to GROUP_PROCESS via goto. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_ASSERT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->assert_depth += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->assert_depth += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Optimize (?!) to (*FAIL) unless it is quantified - which is a weird
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    thing to do, but Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    they contain capturing parentheses there may be a potential use for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    this feature. Not that that applies to a quantified (?!) but we allow
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    it for uniformity. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (pptr[1] == META_KET &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         (pptr[2] < META_ASTERISK || pptr[2] > META_MINMAX_QUERY))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *code++ = OP_FAIL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NOT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->assert_depth += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->assert_depth += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->assert_depth += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->assert_depth += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ATOMIC:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_ONCE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_SCRIPT_RUN;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_NOCAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Process nested bracketed regex. The nesting depth is maintained for the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    benefit of the stackguard function. The test for too deep nesting is now
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    done in parse_regex(). Assertion and DEFINE groups come to GROUP_PROCESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    others come to GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY, to indicate that we need to take
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    note of whether or not they may match an empty string. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    note_group_empty = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GROUP_PROCESS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->parens_depth += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code = bravalue;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    tempcode = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    tempreqvary = cb->req_varyopt;        /* Save value before group */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    length_prevgroup = 0;                 /* Initialize for pre-compile phase */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((group_return =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         compile_regex(
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         options,                         /* The option state */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         &tempcode,                       /* Where to put code (updated) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         &pptr,                           /* Input pointer (updated) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         errorcodeptr,                    /* Where to put an error message */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         skipunits,                       /* Skip over bracket number */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         &subfirstcu,                     /* For possible first char */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         &subfirstcuflags,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         &subreqcu,                       /* For possible last char */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         &subreqcuflags,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         bcptr,                           /* Current branch chain */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         cb,                              /* Compile data block */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL :      /* Actual compile phase */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								           &length_prevgroup              /* Pre-compile phase */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         )) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;  /* Error */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->parens_depth -= 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If that was a non-conditional significant group (not an assertion, not a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    DEFINE) that matches at least one character, then the current item matches
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    a character. Conditionals are handled below. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (note_group_empty && bravalue != OP_COND && group_return > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If we've just compiled an assertion, pop the assert depth. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NA)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->assert_depth -= 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* At the end of compiling, code is still pointing to the start of the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group, while tempcode has been updated to point past the end of the group.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    The parsed pattern pointer (pptr) is on the closing META_KET.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    If this is a conditional bracket, check that there are no more than
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    two branches in the group, or just one if it's a DEFINE group. We do this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in the real compile phase, not in the pre-pass, where the whole group may
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    not be available. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (bravalue == OP_COND && lengthptr == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_UCHAR *tc = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      int condcount = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      do {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         condcount++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         tc += GET(tc,1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      while (*tc != OP_KET);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* A DEFINE group is never obeyed inline (the "condition" is always
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      false). It must have only one branch. Having checked this, change the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      opcode to OP_FALSE. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (code[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEFINE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (condcount > 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR54;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code[LINK_SIZE+1] = OP_FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        bravalue = OP_DEFINE;   /* A flag to suppress char handling below */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* A "normal" conditional group. If there is just one branch, we must not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      make use of its firstcu or reqcu, because this is equivalent to an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      empty second branch. Also, it may match an empty string. If there are two
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      branches, this item must match a character if the group must. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (condcount > 2)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errorcodeptr = ERR27;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (condcount == 1) subfirstcuflags = subreqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else if (group_return > 0) matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In the pre-compile phase, update the length by the length of the group,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    less the brackets at either end. Then reduce the compiled code to just a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    set of non-capturing brackets so that it doesn't use much memory if it is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    duplicated by a quantifier.*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *lengthptr += length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code++;   /* This already contains bravalue */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *code++ = OP_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;    /* No need to waste time with special character handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Otherwise update the main code pointer to the end of the group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code = tempcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* For a DEFINE group, required and first character settings are not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    relevant. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (bravalue == OP_DEFINE) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle updating of the required and first code units for other types of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group. Update for normal brackets of all kinds, and conditions with two
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    branches (see code above). If the bracket is followed by a quantifier with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zero repeat, we have to back off. Hence the definition of zeroreqcu and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcu outside the main loop so that they can be accessed for the back
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    off. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcu = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    groupsetfirstcu = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (bravalue >= OP_ONCE)  /* Not an assertion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If we have not yet set a firstcu in this branch, take it from the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      subpattern, remembering that it was set here so that a repeat of more
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      than one can replicate it as reqcu if necessary. If the subpattern has
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      no firstcu, set "none" for the whole branch. In both cases, a zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      repeat forces firstcu to "none". */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET && subfirstcuflags != REQ_UNSET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          firstcu = subfirstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          firstcuflags = subfirstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          groupsetfirstcu = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If firstcu was previously set, convert the subpattern's firstcu
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      into reqcu if there wasn't one, using the vary flag that was in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      existence beforehand. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE && subreqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        subreqcu = subfirstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        subreqcuflags = subfirstcuflags | tempreqvary;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the subpattern set a required code unit (or set a first code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      that isn't really the first code unit - see above), set it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (subreqcuflags < REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        reqcu = subreqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        reqcuflags = subreqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* For a forward assertion, we take the reqcu, if set, provided that the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group has also set a firstcu. This can be helpful if the pattern that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    follows the assertion doesn't set a different char. For example, it's
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    useful for /(?=abcde).+/. We can't set firstcu for an assertion, however
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    because it leads to incorrect effect for patterns such as /(?=a)a.+/ when
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the "real" "a" would then become a reqcu instead of a firstcu. This is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    overcome by a scan at the end if there's no firstcu, looking for an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    asserted first char. A similar effect for patterns like /(?=.*X)X$/ means
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    we must only take the reqcu when the group also set a firstcu. Otherwise,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in that example, 'X' ends up set for both. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else if ((bravalue == OP_ASSERT || bravalue == OP_ASSERT_NA) &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             subreqcuflags < REQ_NONE && subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      reqcu = subreqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      reqcuflags = subreqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;  /* End of nested group handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle named backreferences and recursions. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      int count, index;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SPTR name;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      BOOL is_dupname = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      named_group *ng = cb->named_groups;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t length = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      name = cb->start_pattern + offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* In the first pass, the names generated in the pre-pass are available,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      but the main name table has not yet been created. Scan the list of names
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      generated in the pre-pass in order to get a number and whether or not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      this name is duplicated. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      groupnumber = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for (unsigned int i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (length == ng->length &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          is_dupname = ng->isdup;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          groupnumber = ng->number;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* For a recursion, that's all that is needed. We can now go to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          the code that handles numerical recursion, applying it to the first
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          group with the given name. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (meta == META_RECURSE_BYNAME)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            meta_arg = groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* For a back reference, update the back reference map and the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          maximum back reference. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb->backref_map |= (groupnumber < 32)? (1u << groupnumber) : 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            cb->top_backref = groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the name was not found we have a bad reference. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (groupnumber == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If a back reference name is not duplicated, we can handle it as
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      a numerical reference. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (!is_dupname)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        meta_arg = groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto HANDLE_SINGLE_REFERENCE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If a back reference name is duplicated, we generate a different
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      opcode to a numerical back reference. In the second pass we must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      search for the index and count in the final name table. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      count = 0;  /* Values for first pass (avoids compiler warning) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      index = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (lengthptr == NULL && !find_dupname_details(name, length, &index,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            &count, errorcodeptr, cb)) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_DNREFI : OP_DNREF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT2INC(code, 0, index);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT2INC(code, 0, count);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle a numerical callout. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code[0] = OP_CALLOUT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT(code, 1, pptr[1]);               /* Offset to next pattern item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE, pptr[2]);   /* Length of next pattern item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code[1 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = pptr[3];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle a callout with a string argument. In the pre-pass we just compute
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the length without generating anything. The length in pptr[3] includes both
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    delimiters; in the actual compile only the first one is copied, but a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    terminating zero is added. Any doubled delimiters within the string make
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    this an overestimate, but it is not worth bothering about. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *lengthptr += pptr[3] + (1 + 4*LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      SKIPOFFSET(pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In the real compile we can copy the string. The starting delimiter is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     included so that the client can discover it if they want. We also pass the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     start offset to help a script language give better error messages. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SPTR pp;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t delimiter;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t length = pptr[3];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_UCHAR *callout_string = code + (1 + 4*LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code[0] = OP_CALLOUT_STR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT(code, 1, pptr[1]);               /* Offset to next pattern item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE, pptr[2]);   /* Length of next pattern item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);         /* Offset to string in pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pp = cb->start_pattern + offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      delimiter = *callout_string++ = *pp++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (delimiter == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        delimiter = CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT(code, 1 + 3*LINK_SIZE, (int)(offset + 1));  /* One after delimiter */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* The syntax of the pattern was checked in the parsing scan. The length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      includes both delimiters, but we have passed the opening one just above,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      so we reduce length before testing it. The test is for > 1 because we do
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      not want to copy the final delimiter. This also ensures that pp[1] is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      accessible. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      while (--length > 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (*pp == delimiter && pp[1] == delimiter)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *callout_string++ = delimiter;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          pp += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          length--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else *callout_string++ = *pp++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *callout_string++ = CHAR_NUL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Set the length of the entire item, the advance to its end. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE, (int)(callout_string - code));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code = callout_string;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle repetition. The different types are all sorted out in the parsing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pass. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_min = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_max = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_min = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_min = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_min = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat_max = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    REPEAT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (previous_matched_char && repeat_min > 0) matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Remember whether this is a variable length repeat, and default to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    single-char opcodes. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    reqvary = (repeat_min == repeat_max)? 0 : REQ_VARY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    op_type = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Adjust first and required code units for a zero repeat. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (repeat_min == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      firstcu = zerofirstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      firstcuflags = zerofirstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      reqcu = zeroreqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      reqcuflags = zeroreqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Note the greediness and possessiveness. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch (meta)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_PLUS_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_QUERY_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      repeat_type = 0;                  /* Force greedy */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      possessive_quantifier = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_PLUS_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_QUERY_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      repeat_type = greedy_non_default;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      repeat_type = greedy_default;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Save start of previous item, in case we have to move it up in order to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    insert something before it, and remember what it was. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    tempcode = previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    op_previous = *previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Now handle repetition for the different types of item. If the repeat
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    minimum and the repeat maximum are both 1, we can ignore the quantifier for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    non-parenthesized items, as they have only one alternative. For anything in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    parentheses, we must not ignore if {1} is possessive. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch (op_previous)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If previous was a character or negated character match, abolish the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      item and generate a repeat item instead. If a char item has a minimum of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      more than one, ensure that it is set in reqcu - it might not be if a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      sequence such as x{3} is the first thing in a branch because the x will
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      have gone into firstcu instead.  */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_CHAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_CHARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      op_type = chartypeoffset[op_previous - OP_CHAR];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Deal with UTF characters that take up more than one code unit. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef MAYBE_UTF_MULTI
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (utf && NOT_FIRSTCU(code[-1]))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_UCHAR *lastchar = code - 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        BACKCHAR(lastchar);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        mclength = (uint32_t)(code - lastchar);   /* Length of UTF character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        memcpy(mcbuffer, lastchar, CU2BYTES(mclength));  /* Save the char */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* MAYBE_UTF_MULTI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle the case of a single code unit - either with no UTF support, or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      with UTF disabled, or for a single-code-unit UTF character. In the latter
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case, for a repeated positive match, get the caseless flag for the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      required code unit from the previous character, because a class like [Aa]
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      sets a caseless A but by now the req_caseopt flag has been reset. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        mcbuffer[0] = code[-1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        mclength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (op_previous <= OP_CHARI && repeat_min > 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          reqcu = mcbuffer[0];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          reqcuflags = cb->req_varyopt;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (op_previous == OP_CHARI) reqcuflags |= REQ_CASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT;  /* Code shared with single character types */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If previous was a character class or a back reference, we put the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      repeat stuff after it, but just skip the item if the repeat was {0,0}. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_XCLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_CLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NCLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_REF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_REFI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_DNREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_DNREFI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (repeat_max == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code = previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_CRSTAR + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (repeat_min == 1 && repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_CRPLUS + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_CRQUERY + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_CRRANGE + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max = 0;  /* 2-byte encoding for max */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If previous is OP_FAIL, it was generated by an empty class []
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      (PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS is set). The other ways in which OP_FAIL can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      generated, that is by (*FAIL) or (?!), disallow a quantifier at parse
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      time. We can just ignore this repeat. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_FAIL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Prior to 10.30, repeated recursions were wrapped in OP_ONCE brackets
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      because pcre2_match() could not handle backtracking into recursively
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      called groups. Now that this backtracking is available, we no longer need
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      to do this. However, we still need to replicate recursions as we do for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      groups so as to have independent backtracking points. We can replicate
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for the minimum number of repeats directly. For optional repeats we now
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      wrap the recursion in OP_BRA brackets and make use of the bracket
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      repetition. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_RECURSE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1 && !possessive_quantifier)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Generate unwrapped repeats for a non-zero minimum, except when the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      minimum is 1 and the maximum unlimited, because that can be handled with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      OP_BRA terminated by OP_KETRMAX/MIN. When the maximum is equal to the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      minimum, we just need to generate the appropriate additional copies.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      Otherwise we need to generate one more, to simulate the situation when
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      the minimum is zero. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (repeat_min > 0 && (repeat_min != 1 || repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int replicate = repeat_min;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_min == repeat_max) replicate--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        integer type when available, otherwise double. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PCRE2_SIZE delta = replicate*(1 + LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)replicate*
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(1 + LINK_SIZE) >
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *lengthptr += delta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else for (int i = 0; i < replicate; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(1 + LINK_SIZE));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          previous = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If the number of repeats is fixed, we are done. Otherwise, adjust
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        the counts and fall through. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_min == repeat_max) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max -= repeat_min;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        repeat_min = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Wrap the recursion call in OP_BRA brackets. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      (void)memmove(previous + 1 + LINK_SIZE, previous, CU2BYTES(1 + LINK_SIZE));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      op_previous = *previous = OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT(previous, 1, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      previous[2 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = OP_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PUT(previous, 3 + 2*LINK_SIZE, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code += 2 + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      length_prevgroup = 3 + 3*LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      group_return = -1;  /* Set "may match empty string" */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Now treat as a repeated OP_BRA. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If previous was a bracket group, we may have to replicate it in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      certain cases. Note that at this point we can encounter only the "basic"
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      bracket opcodes such as BRA and CBRA, as this is the place where they get
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      converted into the more special varieties such as BRAPOS and SBRA.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      Originally, PCRE did not allow repetition of assertions, but now it does,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for Perl compatibility. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_ASSERT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_ASSERT_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_ASSERTBACK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_ASSERTBACK_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_ONCE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_BRA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_CBRA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_COND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int len = (int)(code - previous);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_UCHAR *bralink = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_UCHAR *brazeroptr = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1 && !possessive_quantifier)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Repeating a DEFINE group (or any group where the condition is always
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        FALSE and there is only one branch) is pointless, but Perl allows the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        syntax, so we just ignore the repeat. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (op_previous == OP_COND && previous[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_FALSE &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            previous[GET(previous, 1)] != OP_ALT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when they contain
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        capturing parentheses and/or are optional there are potential uses for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        this feature. PCRE2 used to force the maximum quantifier to 1 on the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        invalid grounds that further repetition was never useful. This was
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        always a bit pointless, since an assertion could be wrapped with a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        repeated group to achieve the effect. General repetition is now
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        permitted, but if the maximum is unlimited it is set to one more than
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        the minimum. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (op_previous < OP_ONCE)    /* Assertion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max = repeat_min + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* The case of a zero minimum is special because of the need to stick
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        OP_BRAZERO in front of it, and because the group appears once in the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        data, whereas in other cases it appears the minimum number of times. For
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        this reason, it is simplest to treat this case separately, as otherwise
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        the code gets far too messy. There are several special subcases when the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        minimum is zero. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_min == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* If the maximum is also zero, we used to just omit the group from
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          the output altogether, like this:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ** if (repeat_max == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          **   {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          **   code = previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          **   goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          **   }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          However, that fails when a group or a subgroup within it is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          referenced as a subroutine from elsewhere in the pattern, so now we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          stick in OP_SKIPZERO in front of it so that it is skipped on
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          execution. As we don't have a list of which groups are referenced, we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cannot do this selectively.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          If the maximum is 1 or unlimited, we just have to stick in the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          BRAZERO and do no more at this point. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_max <= 1 || repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            (void)memmove(previous + 1, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            code++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (repeat_max == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *previous++ = OP_SKIPZERO;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            brazeroptr = previous;    /* Save for possessive optimizing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* If the maximum is greater than 1 and limited, we have to replicate
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          in a nested fashion, sticking OP_BRAZERO before each set of brackets.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          The first one has to be handled carefully because it's the original
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          copy, which has to be moved up. The remainder can be handled by code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          that is common with the non-zero minimum case below. We have to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          adjust the value or repeat_max, since one less copy is required. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            int linkoffset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            (void)memmove(previous + 2 + LINK_SIZE, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            code += 2 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *previous++ = OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* We chain together the bracket link offset fields that have to be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            filled in later when the ends of the brackets are reached. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            linkoffset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(previous - bralink);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            bralink = previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PUTINC(previous, 0, linkoffset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If the minimum is greater than zero, replicate the group as many
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        times as necessary, and adjust the maximum to the number of subsequent
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        copies that we need. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_min > 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            We just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            integer type when available, otherwise double. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              PCRE2_SIZE delta = (repeat_min - 1)*length_prevgroup;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(repeat_min - 1)*
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)length_prevgroup >
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                      (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *lengthptr += delta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* This is compiling for real. If there is a set first code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            for the group, and we have not yet set a "required code unit", set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (groupsetfirstcu && reqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                reqcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                reqcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              for (uint32_t i = 1; i < repeat_min; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                code += len;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max -= repeat_min;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* This code is common to both the zero and non-zero minimum cases. If
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        the maximum is limited, it replicates the group in a nested fashion,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        remembering the bracket starts on a stack. In the case of a zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        minimum, the first one was set up above. In all cases the repeat_max
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        now specifies the number of additional copies needed. Again, we must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        remember to replicate entries on the forward reference list. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          just adjust the length as if we had. For each repetition we must add
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          1 to the length for BRAZERO and for all but the last repetition we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          must add 2 + 2*LINKSIZE to allow for the nesting that occurs. Do some
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          paranoid checks to avoid integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          is a 64-bit integer type when available, otherwise double. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (lengthptr != NULL && repeat_max > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PCRE2_SIZE delta = repeat_max*(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) -
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                        2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;   /* Last one doesn't nest */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)repeat_max *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    > (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *lengthptr += delta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* This is compiling for real */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else for (uint32_t i = repeat_max; i >= 1; i--)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *code++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* All but the final copy start a new nesting, maintaining the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            chain of brackets outstanding. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (i != 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              int linkoffset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *code++ = OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              linkoffset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(code - bralink);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              bralink = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              PUTINC(code, 0, linkoffset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(len));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            code += len;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Now chain through the pending brackets, and fill in their length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          fields (which are holding the chain links pro tem). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          while (bralink != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            int oldlinkoffset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            int linkoffset = (int)(code - bralink + 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PCRE2_UCHAR *bra = code - linkoffset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            oldlinkoffset = GET(bra, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            bralink = (oldlinkoffset == 0)? NULL : bralink - oldlinkoffset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *code++ = OP_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PUTINC(code, 0, linkoffset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PUT(bra, 1, linkoffset);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If the maximum is unlimited, set a repeater in the final copy. For
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        SCRIPT_RUN and ONCE brackets, that's all we need to do. However,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        possessively repeated ONCE brackets can be converted into non-capturing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        brackets, as the behaviour of (?:xx)++ is the same as (?>xx)++ and this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        saves having to deal with possessive ONCEs specially.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        Otherwise, when we are doing the actual compile phase, check to see
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        whether this group is one that could match an empty string. If so,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        convert the initial operator to the S form (e.g. OP_BRA -> OP_SBRA) so
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        that runtime checking can be done. [This check is also applied to ONCE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        and SCRIPT_RUN groups at runtime, but in a different way.]
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        Then, if the quantifier was possessive and the bracket is not a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        conditional, we convert the BRA code to the POS form, and the KET code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        to KETRPOS. (It turns out to be convenient at runtime to detect this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        kind of subpattern at both the start and at the end.) The use of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        special opcodes makes it possible to reduce greatly the stack usage in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        pcre2_match(). If the group is preceded by OP_BRAZERO, convert this to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        OP_BRAPOSZERO.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        Then, if the minimum number of matches is 1 or 0, cancel the possessive
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        flag so that the default action below, of wrapping everything inside
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        atomic brackets, does not happen. When the minimum is greater than 1,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        there will be earlier copies of the group, and so we still have to wrap
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        the whole thing. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PCRE2_UCHAR *ketcode = code - 1 - LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PCRE2_UCHAR *bracode = ketcode - GET(ketcode, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Convert possessive ONCE brackets to non-capturing */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (*bracode == OP_ONCE && possessive_quantifier) *bracode = OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* For non-possessive ONCE and for SCRIPT_RUN brackets, all we need
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          to do is to set the KET. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_SCRIPT_RUN)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Handle non-SCRIPT_RUN and non-ONCE brackets and possessive ONCEs
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (which have been converted to non-capturing above). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* In the compile phase, adjust the opcode if the group can match
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            an empty string. For a conditional group with only one branch, the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            value of group_return will not show "could be empty", so we must
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            check that separately. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (lengthptr == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (group_return < 0) *bracode += OP_SBRA - OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (*bracode == OP_COND && bracode[GET(bracode,1)] != OP_ALT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *bracode = OP_SCOND;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* Handle possessive quantifiers. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (possessive_quantifier)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              /* For COND brackets, we wrap the whole thing in a possessively
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              repeated non-capturing bracket, because we have not invented POS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              versions of the COND opcodes. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (*bracode == OP_COND || *bracode == OP_SCOND)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                int nlen = (int)(code - bracode);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                (void)memmove(bracode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, bracode, CU2BYTES(nlen));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                nlen += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *bracode = (*bracode == OP_COND)? OP_BRAPOS : OP_SBRAPOS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *code++ = OP_KETRPOS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                PUTINC(code, 0, nlen);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                PUT(bracode, 1, nlen);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              /* For non-COND brackets, we modify the BRA code and use KETRPOS. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *bracode += 1;              /* Switch to xxxPOS opcodes */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *ketcode = OP_KETRPOS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              /* If the minimum is zero, mark it as possessive, then unset the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              possessive flag when the minimum is 0 or 1. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (brazeroptr != NULL) *brazeroptr = OP_BRAPOSZERO;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (repeat_min < 2) possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* Non-possessive quantifier */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If previous was a character type match (\d or similar), abolish it and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      create a suitable repeat item. The code is shared with single-character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      repeats by setting op_type to add a suitable offset into repeat_type.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      Note the the Unicode property types will be present only when
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      SUPPORT_UNICODE is defined, but we don't wrap the little bits of code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      here because it just makes it horribly messy. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (op_previous >= OP_EODN)   /* Not a character type - internal error */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR10;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        int prop_type, prop_value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_UCHAR *oldcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        op_type = OP_TYPESTAR - OP_STAR;      /* Use type opcodes */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        mclength = 0;                         /* Not a character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (op_previous == OP_PROP || op_previous == OP_NOTPROP)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          prop_type = previous[1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          prop_value = previous[2];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Come here from just above with a character in mcbuffer/mclength. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          prop_type = prop_value = -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* At this point, if prop_type == prop_value == -1 we either have a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        character in mcbuffer when mclength is greater than zero, or we have
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        mclength zero, in which case there is a non-property character type in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        op_previous. If prop_type/value are not negative, we have a property
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        character type in op_previous. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        oldcode = code;                   /* Save where we were */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code = previous;                  /* Usually overwrite previous item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* If the maximum is zero then the minimum must also be zero; Perl allows
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        this case, so we do too - by simply omitting the item altogether. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_max == 0) goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Combine the op_type with the repeat_type */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        repeat_type += op_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* A minimum of zero is handled either as the special case * or ?, or as
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        an UPTO, with the maximum given. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repeat_min == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else if (repeat_max == 1) *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* A repeat minimum of 1 is optimized into some special cases. If the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        maximum is unlimited, we use OP_PLUS. Otherwise, the original item is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        left in place and, if the maximum is greater than 1, we use OP_UPTO with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        one less than the maximum. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (repeat_min == 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *code++ = OP_PLUS + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            code = oldcode;  /* Leave previous item in place */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (repeat_max == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max - 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* The case {n,n} is just an EXACT, while the general case {n,m} is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        handled as an EXACT followed by an UPTO or STAR or QUERY. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *code++ = OP_EXACT + op_type;  /* NB EXACT doesn't have repeat_type */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          /* Unless repeat_max equals repeat_min, fill in the data for EXACT,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          and then generate the second opcode. For a repeated Unicode property
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          match, there are two extra values that define the required property,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          and mclength is set zero to indicate this. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (repeat_max != repeat_min)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (mclength > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              code += mclength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *code++ = op_previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (prop_type >= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *code++ = prop_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *code++ = prop_value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            /* Now set up the following opcode */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              repeat_max -= repeat_min;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              if (repeat_max == 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Fill in the character or character type for the final opcode. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (mclength > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          code += mclength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *code++ = op_previous;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (prop_type >= 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *code++ = prop_type;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            *code++ = prop_value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }  /* End of switch on different op_previous values */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If the character following a repeat is '+', possessive_quantifier is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    TRUE. For some opcodes, there are special alternative opcodes for this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case. For anything else, we wrap the entire repeated item inside OP_ONCE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    brackets. Logically, the '+' notation is just syntactic sugar, taken from
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Sun's Java package, but the special opcodes can optimize it.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Some (but not all) possessively repeated subpatterns have already been
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    completely handled in the code just above. For them, possessive_quantifier
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    is always FALSE at this stage. Note that the repeated item starts at
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    tempcode, not at previous, which might be the first part of a string whose
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (former) last char we repeated. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (possessive_quantifier)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      int len;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Possessifying an EXACT quantifier has no effect, so we can ignore it.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      However, QUERY, STAR, or UPTO may follow (for quantifiers such as {5,6},
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {5,}, or {5,10}). We skip over an EXACT item; if the length of what
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      remains is greater than zero, there's a further opcode that can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      handled. If not, do nothing, leaving the EXACT alone. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      switch(*tempcode)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_TYPEEXACT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode] +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ((tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          || tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)? 2 : 0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* CHAR opcodes are used for exacts whose count is 1. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_CHAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_CHARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_NOTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_EXACT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_EXACTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_NOTEXACT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_NOTEXACTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          tempcode += GET_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* For the class opcodes, the repeat operator appears at the end;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        adjust tempcode to point to it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_CLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_NCLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        tempcode += 1 + 32/sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case OP_XCLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        tempcode += GET(tempcode, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If tempcode is equal to code (which points to the end of the repeated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      item), it means we have skipped an EXACT item but there is no following
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      QUERY, STAR, or UPTO; the value of len will be 0, and we do nothing. In
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      all other cases, tempcode will be pointing to the repeat opcode, and will
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      be less than code, so the value of len will be greater than 0. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      len = (int)(code - tempcode);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (len > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        unsigned int repcode = *tempcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* There is a table for possessifying opcodes, all of which are less
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        than OP_CALLOUT. A zero entry means there is no possessified version.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (repcode < OP_CALLOUT && opcode_possessify[repcode] > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *tempcode = opcode_possessify[repcode];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* For opcode without a special possessified version, wrap the item in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        ONCE brackets. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (void)memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, CU2BYTES(len));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *code++ = OP_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PUTINC(code, 0, len);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* We set the "follows varying string" flag for subsequently encountered
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    reqcus if it isn't already set and we have just passed a varying length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    item. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    END_REPEAT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->req_varyopt |= reqvary;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle a 32-bit data character with a value greater than META_END. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BIGVALUE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto NORMAL_CHAR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===============================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle a back reference by number, which is the meta argument. The
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pattern offsets for back references to group numbers less than 10 are held
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in a special vector, to avoid using more than two parsed pattern elements
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in 64-bit environments. We only need the offset to the first occurrence,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    because if that doesn't fail, subsequent ones will also be OK. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg < 10) offset = cb->small_ref_offset[meta_arg];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg > cb->bracount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR15;  /* Non-existent subpattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Come here from named backref handling when the reference is to a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    single group (that is, not to a duplicated name). The back reference
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    data will have already been updated. We must disable firstcu if not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    set, to cope with cases like (?=(\w+))\1: which would otherwise set ':'
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    later. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    HANDLE_SINGLE_REFERENCE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_REFI : OP_REF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT2INC(code, 0, meta_arg);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Update the map of back references, and keep the highest one. We
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    could do this in parse_regex() for numerical back references, but not
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for named back references, because we don't know the numbers to which
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    named back references refer. So we do it all in this function. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->backref_map |= (meta_arg < 32)? (1u << meta_arg) : 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = meta_arg;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===============================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle recursion by inserting the number of the called group (which is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the meta argument) after OP_RECURSE. At the end of compiling the pattern is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    scanned and these numbers are replaced by offsets within the pattern. It is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    done like this to avoid problems with forward references and adjusting
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    offsets when groups are duplicated and moved (as discovered in previous
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    implementations). Note that a recursion does not have a set first
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg > cb->bracount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR15;  /* Non-existent subpattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code = OP_RECURSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT(code, 1, meta_arg);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    groupsetfirstcu = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->had_recurse = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===============================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle capturing parentheses; the number is the meta argument. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bravalue = OP_CBRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    skipunits = IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE, meta_arg);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->lastcapture = meta_arg;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===============================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle escape sequence items. For ones like \d, the ESC_values are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    arranged to be the same as the corresponding OP_values in the default case
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    when PCRE2_UCP is not set (which is the only case in which they will appear
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    here).
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    Note: \Q and \E are never seen here, as they were dealt with in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    parse_pattern(). Neither are numerical back references or recursions, which
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    were turned into META_BACKREF or META_RECURSE items, respectively. \k and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \g, when followed by names, are turned into META_BACKREF_BYNAME or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    META_RECURSE_BYNAME. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ESCAPE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* We can test for escape sequences that consume a character because their
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    values lie between ESC_b and ESC_Z; this may have to change if any new ones
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    are ever created. For these sequences, we disable the setting of a first
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    character if it hasn't already been set. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg > ESC_b && meta_arg < ESC_Z)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Set values to reset to if this is followed by a zero repeat. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcu = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If Unicode is not supported, \P and \p are not allowed and are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    faulted at parse time, so will never appear here. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg == ESC_P || meta_arg == ESC_p)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t ptype = *(++pptr) >> 16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t pdata = *pptr & 0xffff;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* The special case of \p{Any} is compiled to OP_ALLANY so as to benefit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      from the auto-anchoring code. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (meta_arg == ESC_p && ptype == PT_ANY)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_ALLANY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = (meta_arg == ESC_p)? OP_PROP : OP_NOTPROP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = ptype;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = pdata;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;  /* End META_ESCAPE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* \K is forbidden in lookarounds since 10.38 because that's what Perl has
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    done. However, there's an option, in case anyone was relying on it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (cb->assert_depth > 0 && meta_arg == ESC_K &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (cb->cx->extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_LOOKAROUND_BSK) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR99;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* For the rest (including \X when Unicode is supported - if not it's
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    faulted at parse time), the OP value is the escape value when PCRE2_UCP is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    not set; if it is set, these escapes do not show up here because they are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    converted into Unicode property tests in parse_regex(). Note that \b and \B
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    do a one-character lookbehind, and \A also behaves as if it does. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta_arg == ESC_C) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASBKC; /* Record */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((meta_arg == ESC_b || meta_arg == ESC_B || meta_arg == ESC_A) &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         cb->max_lookbehind == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->max_lookbehind = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In non-UTF mode, and for both 32-bit modes, we turn \C into OP_ALLANY
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    instead of OP_ANYBYTE so that it works in DFA mode and in lookbehinds. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = (meta_arg == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : meta_arg;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = (!utf && meta_arg == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : meta_arg;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;  /* End META_ESCAPE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* ===================================================================*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle an unrecognized meta value. A parsed pattern value less than
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    META_END is a literal. Otherwise we have a problem. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta >= META_END)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      fprintf(stderr, "** Unrecognized parsed pattern item 0x%.8x\n", *pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errorcodeptr = ERR89;  /* Internal error - unrecognized. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle a literal character. We come here by goto in the case of a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    32-bit, non-UTF character whose value is greater than META_END. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    NORMAL_CHAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    meta = *pptr;     /* Get the full 32 bits */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    NORMAL_CHAR_SET:  /* Character is already in meta */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    matched_char = TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* For caseless UTF or UCP mode, check whether this character has more than
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    one other case. If so, generate a special OP_PROP item instead of OP_CHARI.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((utf||ucp) && (options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t caseset = UCD_CASESET(meta);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (caseset != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = OP_PROP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = PT_CLIST;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *code++ = caseset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          firstcuflags = zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;  /* End handling this meta item */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Caseful matches, or caseless and not one of the multicase characters. We
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    come here by goto in the case of a positive class that contains only
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case-partners of a character with just two cases; matched_char has already
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    been set TRUE and options fudged if necessary. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    CLASS_CASELESS_CHAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Get the character's code units into mcbuffer, with the length in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    mclength. When not in UTF mode, the length is always 1. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (utf) mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(meta, mcbuffer); else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      mclength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      mcbuffer[0] = meta;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Generate the appropriate code */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_CHARI : OP_CHAR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += mclength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Remember if \r or \n were seen */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_CR || mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_NL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Set the first and required code units appropriately. If no previous
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    first code unit, set it from this character, but revert to none on a zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    repeat. Otherwise, leave the firstcu value alone, and don't change it on
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    a zero repeat. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zeroreqcu = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If the character is more than one code unit long, we can set a single
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      firstcu only if it is not to be matched caselessly. Multiple possible
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      starting code units may be picked up later in the studying code. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        firstcu = mcbuffer[0];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        firstcuflags = req_caseopt;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (mclength != 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          reqcu = code[-1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          reqcuflags = cb->req_varyopt;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else firstcuflags = reqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* firstcu was previously set; we can set reqcu only if the length is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    1 or the matching is caseful. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zerofirstcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zeroreqcu = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        reqcu = code[-1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        reqcuflags = req_caseopt | cb->req_varyopt;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If caselessness was temporarily instated, reset it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (reset_caseful)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      options &= ~PCRE2_CASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      req_caseopt = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      reset_caseful = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;    /* End literal character handling */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }         /* End of big switch */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }           /* End of big loop */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Control never reaches here. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*   Compile regex: a sequence of alternatives    *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* On entry, pptr is pointing past the bracket meta, but on return it points to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the closing bracket or META_END. The code variable is pointing at the code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								into which the BRA operator has been stored. This function is used during the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pre-compile phase when we are trying to find out the amount of memory needed,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								as well as during the real compile phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the two phases.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options           option bits, including any changes for this subpattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  codeptr           -> the address of the current code pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptrptr           -> the address of the current parsed pattern pointer
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcodeptr      -> pointer to error code variable
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  skipunits         skip this many code units at start (for brackets and OP_COND)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  firstcuptr        place to put the first required code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  firstcuflagsptr   place to put the first code unit flags
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reqcuptr          place to put the last required code unit
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reqcuflagsptr     place to put the last required code unit flags
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  bcptr             pointer to the chain of currently open branches
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb                points to the data block with tables pointers etc.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:            0 There has been an error
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   +1 Success, this group must match at least one character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   -1 Success, this group may match an empty string
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compile_regex(uint32_t options, PCRE2_UCHAR **codeptr, uint32_t **pptrptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t skipunits, uint32_t *firstcuptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t *firstcuflagsptr, uint32_t *reqcuptr, uint32_t *reqcuflagsptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  branch_chain *bcptr, compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SIZE *lengthptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *code = *codeptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *last_branch = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *start_bracket = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL lookbehind;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								open_capitem capitem;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int capnumber = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int okreturn = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t firstcu, reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t lookbehindlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t branchfirstcu, branchreqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t branchfirstcuflags, branchreqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE length;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								branch_chain bc;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If set, call the external function that checks for stack availability. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (cb->cx->stack_guard != NULL &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb->cx->stack_guard(cb->parens_depth, cb->cx->stack_guard_data))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorcodeptr= ERR33;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Miscellaneous initialization */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								bc.outer = bcptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								bc.current_branch = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								firstcu = reqcu = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								firstcuflags = reqcuflags = REQ_UNSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Accumulate the length for use in the pre-compile phase. Start with the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length of the BRA and KET and any extra code units that are required at the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								beginning. We accumulate in a local variable to save frequent testing of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								lengthptr for NULL. We cannot do this by looking at the value of 'code' at the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								start and end of each alternative, because compiled items are discarded during
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the pre-compile phase so that the workspace is not exceeded. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length = 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE + skipunits;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Remember if this is a lookbehind assertion, and if it is, save its length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								and skip over the pattern offset. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								lookbehind = *code == OP_ASSERTBACK ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             *code == OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             *code == OP_ASSERTBACK_NA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (lookbehind)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lookbehindlength = META_DATA(pptr[-1]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								else lookbehindlength = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If this is a capturing subpattern, add to the chain of open capturing items
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								so that we can detect them if (*ACCEPT) is encountered. Note that only OP_CBRA
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								need be tested here; changing this opcode to one of its variants, e.g.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								OP_SCBRAPOS, happens later, after the group has been compiled. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (*code == OP_CBRA)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  capnumber = GET2(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  capitem.number = capnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  capitem.next = cb->open_caps;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  capitem.assert_depth = cb->assert_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb->open_caps = &capitem;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Offset is set zero to mark that this bracket is still open */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PUT(code, 1, 0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								code += 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipunits;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Loop for each alternative branch */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int branch_return;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Insert OP_REVERSE if this is as lookbehind assertion. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (lookbehind && lookbehindlength > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code++ = OP_REVERSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUTINC(code, 0, lookbehindlength);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Now compile the branch; in the pre-compile phase its length gets added
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  into the length. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((branch_return =
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        compile_branch(&options, &code, &pptr, errorcodeptr, &branchfirstcu,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          &branchfirstcuflags, &branchreqcu, &branchreqcuflags, &bc,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb, (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : &length)) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If a branch can match an empty string, so can the whole group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (branch_return < 0) okreturn = -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* In the real compile phase, there is some post-processing to be done. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (lengthptr == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If this is the first branch, the firstcu and reqcu values for the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    branch become the values for the regex. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*last_branch != OP_ALT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      firstcu = branchfirstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      firstcuflags = branchfirstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      reqcu = branchreqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      reqcuflags = branchreqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If this is not the first branch, the first char and reqcu have to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    match the values from all the previous branches, except that if the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    previous value for reqcu didn't have REQ_VARY set, it can still match,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    and we set REQ_VARY for the group from this branch's value. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If we previously had a firstcu, but it doesn't match the new branch,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      we have to abandon the firstcu for the regex, but if there was
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      previously no reqcu, it takes on the value of the old firstcu. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcuflags != branchfirstcuflags || firstcu != branchfirstcu)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (firstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (reqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            reqcu = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            reqcuflags = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        firstcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* If we (now or from before) have no firstcu, a firstcu from the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      branch becomes a reqcu if there isn't a branch reqcu. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE && branchfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          branchreqcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        branchreqcu = branchfirstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        branchreqcuflags = branchfirstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Now ensure that the reqcus match */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (((reqcuflags & ~REQ_VARY) != (branchreqcuflags & ~REQ_VARY)) ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          reqcu != branchreqcu)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        reqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        reqcu = branchreqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        reqcuflags |= branchreqcuflags; /* To "or" REQ_VARY if present */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Handle reaching the end of the expression, either ')' or end of pattern.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  In the real compile phase, go back through the alternative branches and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reverse the chain of offsets, with the field in the BRA item now becoming an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  offset to the first alternative. If there are no alternatives, it points to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  the end of the group. The length in the terminating ket is always the length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  of the whole bracketed item. Return leaving the pointer at the terminating
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  char. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (META_CODE(*pptr) != META_ALT)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (lengthptr == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SIZE branch_length = code - last_branch;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      do
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PCRE2_SIZE prev_length = GET(last_branch, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        PUT(last_branch, 1, branch_length);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        branch_length = prev_length;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        last_branch -= branch_length;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      while (branch_length > 0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fill in the ket */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code = OP_KET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* If it was a capturing subpattern, remove the block from the chain. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (capnumber > 0) cb->open_caps = cb->open_caps->next;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Set values to pass back */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *codeptr = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *pptrptr = pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *firstcuptr = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *firstcuflagsptr = firstcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *reqcuptr = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *reqcuflagsptr = reqcuflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *lengthptr += length;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return okreturn;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Another branch follows. In the pre-compile phase, we can move the code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pointer back to where it was for the start of the first branch. (That is,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pretend that each branch is the only one.)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  In the real compile phase, insert an ALT node. Its length field points back
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  to the previous branch while the bracket remains open. At the end the chain
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  is reversed. It's done like this so that the start of the bracket has a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  zero offset until it is closed, making it possible to detect recursion. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (lengthptr != NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code = *codeptr + 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipunits;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *code = OP_ALT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - last_branch));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    bc.current_branch = last_branch = code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Set the lookbehind length (if not in a lookbehind the value will be zero)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  and then advance past the vertical bar. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lookbehindlength = META_DATA(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Control never reaches here */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*          Check for anchored pattern            *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Try to find out if this is an anchored regular expression. Consider each
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								alternative branch. If they all start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC, or with a bracket
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								all of whose alternatives start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC (recurse ad lib), then
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								it's anchored. However, if this is a multiline pattern, then only OP_SOD will
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								be found, because ^ generates OP_CIRCM in that mode.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								We can also consider a regex to be anchored if OP_SOM starts all its branches.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								This is the code for \G, which means "match at start of match position, taking
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								into account the match offset".
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								A branch is also implicitly anchored if it starts with .* and DOTALL is set,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								because that will try the rest of the pattern at all possible matching points,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								so there is no point trying again.... er ....
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								.... except when the .* appears inside capturing parentheses, and there is a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								subsequent back reference to those parentheses. We haven't enough information
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								to catch that case precisely.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								At first, the best we could do was to detect when .* was in capturing brackets
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								and the highest back reference was greater than or equal to that level.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								However, by keeping a bitmap of the first 31 back references, we can catch some
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								of the more common cases more precisely.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								... A second exception is when the .* appears inside an atomic group, because
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								this prevents the number of characters it matches from being adjusted.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code           points to start of the compiled pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   the less precise approach
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb             points to the compile data block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  atomcount      atomic group level
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  inassert       TRUE if in an assertion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:     TRUE or FALSE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is_anchored(PCRE2_SPTR code, uint32_t bracket_map, compile_block *cb,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int atomcount, BOOL inassert)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								do {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code(
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   int op = *scode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Non-capturing brackets */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Capturing brackets */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     uint32_t new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1u << n) : 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_anchored(scode, new_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Positive forward assertion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Condition. If there is no second branch, it can't be anchored. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_COND || op == OP_SCOND)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (scode[GET(scode,1)] != OP_ALT) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Atomic groups */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_ONCE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount + 1, inassert))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* .* is not anchored unless DOTALL is set (which generates OP_ALLANY) and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   it isn't in brackets that are or may be referenced or inside an atomic
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   group or an assertion. Also the pattern must not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   because these break the feature. Consider, for example, /(?s).*?(*PRUNE)b/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   with the subject "aab", which matches "b", i.e. not at the start of a line.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   There is also an option that disables auto-anchoring. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if ((op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (scode[1] != OP_ALLANY || (bracket_map & cb->backref_map) != 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         atomcount > 0 || cb->had_pruneorskip || inassert ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         (cb->external_options & PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Check for explicit anchoring */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op != OP_SOD && op != OP_SOM && op != OP_CIRC) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   code += GET(code, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (*code == OP_ALT);   /* Loop for each alternative */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*         Check for starting with ^ or .*        *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is called to find out if every branch starts with ^ or .* so that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								"first char" processing can be done to speed things up in multiline
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								matching and for non-DOTALL patterns that start with .* (which must start at
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the beginning or after \n). As in the case of is_anchored() (see above), we
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								have to take account of back references to capturing brackets that contain .*
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								because in that case we can't make the assumption. Also, the appearance of .*
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								inside atomic brackets or in an assertion, or in a pattern that contains *PRUNE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								or *SKIP does not count, because once again the assumption no longer holds.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code           points to start of the compiled pattern or a group
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   the less precise approach
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb             points to the compile data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  atomcount      atomic group level
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  inassert       TRUE if in an assertion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:         TRUE or FALSE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is_startline(PCRE2_SPTR code, unsigned int bracket_map, compile_block *cb,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int atomcount, BOOL inassert)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								do {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code(
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   int op = *scode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* If we are at the start of a conditional assertion group, *both* the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   conditional assertion *and* what follows the condition must satisfy the test
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   for start of line. Other kinds of condition fail. Note that there may be an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   auto-callout at the start of a condition. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   if (op == OP_COND)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT) scode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       else if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT_STR) scode += GET(scode, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     switch (*scode)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       case OP_CREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       case OP_DNCREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       case OP_RREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       case OP_DNRREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       case OP_FAIL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       case OP_FALSE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       case OP_TRUE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       default:     /* Assertion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       do scode += GET(scode, 1); while (*scode == OP_ALT);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     scode = first_significant_code(scode, FALSE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     op = *scode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Non-capturing brackets */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Capturing brackets */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1u << n) : 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_startline(scode, new_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Positive forward assertions */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Atomic brackets */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_ONCE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount + 1, inassert))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* .* means "start at start or after \n" if it isn't in atomic brackets or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   brackets that may be referenced or an assertion, and as long as the pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   does not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, because these break the feature. Consider,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   for example, /.*?a(*PRUNE)b/ with the subject "aab", which matches "ab",
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   i.e. not at the start of a line. There is also an option that disables this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   optimization. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (scode[1] != OP_ANY || (bracket_map & cb->backref_map) != 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         atomcount > 0 || cb->had_pruneorskip || inassert ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         (cb->external_options & PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Check for explicit circumflex; anything else gives a FALSE result. Note
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   in particular that this includes atomic brackets OP_ONCE because the number
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   of characters matched by .* cannot be adjusted inside them. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   else if (op != OP_CIRC && op != OP_CIRCM) return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   /* Move on to the next alternative */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   code += GET(code, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (*code == OP_ALT);  /* Loop for each alternative */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*   Scan compiled regex for recursion reference  *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds an instance of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								OP_RECURSE.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code        points to start of expression
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  utf         TRUE in UTF mode
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:      pointer to the opcode for OP_RECURSE, or NULL if not found
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static PCRE2_SPTR
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								find_recurse(PCRE2_SPTR code, BOOL utf)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_UCHAR c = *code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c == OP_RECURSE) return code;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit map.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  This includes negated single high-valued characters. CALLOUT_STR is used for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  callouts with string arguments. In both cases the length in the table is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else if (c == OP_CALLOUT_STR) code += GET(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  two code units of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  we must add in its length. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch(c)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPESTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_TYPEEXACT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        code += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_COMMIT_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_SKIP_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_THEN_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      code += code[1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In UTF-8 and UTF-16 modes, opcodes that are followed by a character may
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    be followed by a multi-unit character. The length in the table is a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    minimum, so we have to arrange to skip the extra units. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef MAYBE_UTF_MULTI
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (utf) switch(c)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_CHAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_CHARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_EXACT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_EXACTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTEXACT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTEXACTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_UPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_UPTOI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTUPTOI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINUPTOI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSUPTOI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_STAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_STARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTSTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTSTARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINSTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINSTARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSSTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSSTARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_PLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINPLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSPLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_QUERYI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTQUERYI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_MINQUERYI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_POSQUERYI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* MAYBE_UTF_MULTI */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*    Check for asserted fixed first code unit    *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* During compilation, the "first code unit" settings from forward assertions
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								are discarded, because they can cause conflicts with actual literals that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								follow. However, if we end up without a first code unit setting for an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unanchored pattern, it is worth scanning the regex to see if there is an
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								initial asserted first code unit. If all branches start with the same asserted
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								code unit, or with a non-conditional bracket all of whose alternatives start
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								with the same asserted code unit (recurse ad lib), then we return that code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unit, with the flags set to zero or REQ_CASELESS; otherwise return zero with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								REQ_NONE in the flags.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  code       points to start of compiled pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  flags      points to the first code unit flags
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  inassert   non-zero if in an assertion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:     the fixed first code unit, or 0 with REQ_NONE in flags
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static uint32_t
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								find_firstassertedcu(PCRE2_SPTR code, uint32_t *flags, uint32_t inassert)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t c = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t cflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*flags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								do {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   uint32_t d;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   uint32_t dflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   int xl = (*code == OP_CBRA || *code == OP_SCBRA ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             *code == OP_CBRAPOS || *code == OP_SCBRAPOS)? IMM2_SIZE:0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code(code + 1+LINK_SIZE + xl, TRUE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   PCRE2_UCHAR op = *scode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   switch(op)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_BRA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_BRAPOS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_CBRA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_SCBRA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_CBRAPOS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_SCBRAPOS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_ASSERT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_ASSERT_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_ONCE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     d = find_firstassertedcu(scode, &dflags, inassert +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       ((op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA)?1:0));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (dflags >= REQ_NONE) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = d; cflags = dflags; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       else if (c != d || cflags != dflags) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_EXACT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_CHAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_MINPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_POSPLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (inassert == 0) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = scode[1]; cflags = 0; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_EXACTI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_CHARI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_PLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_MINPLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     case OP_POSPLUSI:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (inassert == 0) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     /* If the character is more than one code unit long, we cannot set its
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     first code unit when matching caselessly. Later scanning may pick up
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     multiple code units. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (scode[1] >= 0x80) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (scode[1] >= 0xd800 && scode[1] <= 0xdfff) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = scode[1]; cflags = REQ_CASELESS; }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   code += GET(code, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (*code == OP_ALT);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*flags = cflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*     Add an entry to the name/number table      *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called between compiling passes to add an entry to the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								name/number table, maintaining alphabetical order. Checking for permitted
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								and forbidden duplicates has already been done.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb           the compile data block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  name         the name to add
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  length       the length of the name
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  groupno      the group number
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  tablecount   the count of names in the table so far
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:       nothing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static void
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								add_name_to_table(compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SPTR name, int length,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  unsigned int groupno, uint32_t tablecount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *slot = cb->name_table;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (i = 0; i < tablecount; i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int crc = memcmp(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, CU2BYTES(length));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (crc == 0 && slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    crc = -1; /* Current name is a substring */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Make space in the table and break the loop for an earlier name. For a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  duplicate or later name, carry on. We do this for duplicates so that in the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  simple case (when ?(| is not used) they are in order of their numbers. In all
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cases they are in the order in which they appear in the pattern. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (crc < 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (void)memmove(slot + cb->name_entry_size, slot,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      CU2BYTES((tablecount - i) * cb->name_entry_size));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Continue the loop for a later or duplicate name */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  slot += cb->name_entry_size;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PUT2(slot, 0, groupno);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memcpy(slot + IMM2_SIZE, name, CU2BYTES(length));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Add a terminating zero and fill the rest of the slot with zeroes so that
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the memory is all initialized. Otherwise valgrind moans about uninitialized
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memory when saving serialized compiled patterns. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memset(slot + IMM2_SIZE + length, 0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  CU2BYTES(cb->name_entry_size - length - IMM2_SIZE));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*             Skip in parsed pattern             *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called to skip parts of the parsed pattern when finding the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length of a lookbehind branch. It is called after (*ACCEPT) and (*FAIL) to find
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the end of the branch, it is called to skip over an internal lookaround or
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								(DEFINE) group, and it is also called to skip to the end of a class, during
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								which it will never encounter nested groups (but there's no need to have
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								special code for that).
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								When called to find the end of a branch or group, pptr must point to the first
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								meta code inside the branch, not the branch-starting code. In other cases it
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								can point to the item that causes the function to be called.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptr       current pointer to skip from
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  skiptype   PSKIP_CLASS when skipping to end of class
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             PSKIP_ALT when META_ALT ends the skip
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             PSKIP_KET when only META_KET ends the skip
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:     new value of pptr
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								             NULL if META_END is reached - should never occur
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               or for an unknown meta value - likewise
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static uint32_t *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								parsed_skip(uint32_t *pptr, uint32_t skiptype)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t nestlevel = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;; pptr++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t meta = META_CODE(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  switch(meta)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:  /* Just skip over most items */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (meta < META_END) continue;  /* Literal */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* This should never occur. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_END:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The data for these items is variable in length. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF:  /* Offset is present only if group >= 10 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (META_DATA(*pptr) >= 10) pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ESCAPE:   /* A few escapes are followed by data items. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch (META_DATA(*pptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_P:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_p:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_g:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case ESC_k:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MARK:     /* Add the length of the name. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += pptr[1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* These are the "active" items in this loop. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_END:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (skiptype == PSKIP_CLASS) return pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ATOMIC:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_ASSERT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_DEFINE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_VERSION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_NOCAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    nestlevel++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ALT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (nestlevel == 0 && skiptype == PSKIP_ALT) return pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_KET:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (nestlevel == 0) return pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    nestlevel--;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* The extra data item length for each meta is in a table. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  meta = (meta >> 16) & 0x7fff;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (meta >= sizeof(meta_extra_lengths)) return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptr += meta_extra_lengths[meta];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Control never reaches here */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*       Find length of a parsed group            *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This is called for nested groups within a branch of a lookbehind whose
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length is being computed. If all the branches in the nested group have the same
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length, that is OK. On entry, the pointer must be at the first element after
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the group initializing code. On exit it points to OP_KET. Caching is used to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								improve processing speed when the same capturing group occurs many times.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptrptr     pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  isinline    FALSE if a reference or recursion; TRUE for inline group
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errcodeptr  pointer to the errorcode
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lcptr       pointer to the loop counter
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  group       number of captured group or -1 for a non-capturing group
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb          pointer to the compile data
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:      the group length or a negative number
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								get_grouplength(uint32_t **pptrptr, BOOL isinline, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   int group, parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int branchlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int grouplength = -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The cache can be used only if there is no possibility of there being two
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								groups with the same number. We do not need to set the end pointer for a group
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								that is being processed as a back reference or recursion, but we must do so for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								an inline group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (group > 0 && (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t groupinfo = cb->groupinfo[group];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((groupinfo & GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH) != 0) return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((groupinfo & GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (isinline) *pptrptr = parsed_skip(*pptrptr, PSKIP_KET);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return groupinfo & GI_FIXED_LENGTH_MASK;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Scan the group. In this case we find the end pointer of necessity. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for(;;)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  branchlength = get_branchlength(pptrptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (branchlength < 0) goto ISNOTFIXED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (grouplength == -1) grouplength = branchlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    else if (grouplength != branchlength) goto ISNOTFIXED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (**pptrptr == META_KET) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *pptrptr += 1;   /* Skip META_ALT */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (group > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb->groupinfo[group] |= (uint32_t)(GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH | grouplength);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return grouplength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ISNOTFIXED:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (group > 0) cb->groupinfo[group] |= GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*        Find length of a parsed branch          *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Return a fixed length for a branch in a lookbehind, giving an error if the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length is not fixed. On entry, *pptrptr points to the first element inside the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								branch. On exit it is set to point to the ALT or KET.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptrptr     pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errcodeptr  pointer to error code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lcptr       pointer to loop counter
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb          pointer to compile block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:      the length, or a negative value on error
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								get_branchlength(uint32_t **pptrptr, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int branchlength = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int grouplength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t lastitemlength = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								parsed_recurse_check this_recurse;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* A large and/or complex regex can take too long to process. This can happen
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								more often when (?| groups are present in the pattern because their length
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cannot be cached. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((*lcptr)++ > 2000)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errcodeptr = ERR35;  /* Lookbehind is too complicated */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Scan the branch, accumulating the length. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (;; pptr++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_recurse_check *r;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t *gptr, *gptrend;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t escape;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t group = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t itemlength = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (*pptr < META_END)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    itemlength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else switch (META_CODE(*pptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_KET:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ALT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* (*ACCEPT) and (*FAIL) terminate the branch, but we must skip to the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    actual termination. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ACCEPT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_FAIL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr = parsed_skip(pptr, PSKIP_ALT);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (pptr == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += pptr[1] + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CIRCUMFLEX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOLLAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_OPTIONS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BIGVALUE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    itemlength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    itemlength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr = parsed_skip(pptr, PSKIP_CLASS);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (pptr == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    itemlength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3 + SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Only some escapes consume a character. Of those, \R and \X are never
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    allowed because they might match more than character. \C is allowed only in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    32-bit and non-UTF 8/16-bit modes. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ESCAPE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    escape = META_DATA(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (escape == ESC_R || escape == ESC_X) return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH != 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0 && escape == ESC_C)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errcodeptr = ERR36;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      itemlength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (escape == ESC_p || escape == ESC_P) pptr++;  /* Skip prop data */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Lookaheads do not contribute to the length of this branch, but they may
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    contain lookbehinds within them whose lengths need to be set. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errcodeptr = check_lookbehinds(pptr + 1, &pptr, recurses, cb, lcptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*errcodeptr != 0) return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Ignore any qualifiers that follow a lookahead assertion. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    switch (pptr[1])
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_ASTERISK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_PLUS_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_PLUS_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_QUERY_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_QUERY_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_MINMAX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* A nested lookbehind does not contribute any length to this lookbehind,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    but must itself be checked and have its lengths set. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!set_lookbehind_lengths(&pptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Back references and recursions are handled by very similar code. At this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    stage, the names generated in the parsing pass are available, but the main
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    name table has not yet been created. So for the named varieties, scan the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    list of names in order to get the number of the first one in the pattern,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    and whether or not this name is duplicated. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto ISNOTFIXED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      int i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SPTR name;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      BOOL is_dupname = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      named_group *ng = cb->named_groups;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t meta_code = META_CODE(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t length = *(++pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      name = cb->start_pattern + offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (length == ng->length && PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          group = ng->number;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          is_dupname = ng->isdup;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (group == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        *errcodeptr = ERR15;  /* Non-existent subpattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* A numerical back reference can be fixed length if duplicate capturing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      groups are not being used. A non-duplicate named back reference can also
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      be handled. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (meta_code == META_RECURSE_BYNAME ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          (!is_dupname && (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) == 0))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        goto RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH;  /* Handle as a numbered version. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto ISNOTFIXED;                     /* Duplicate name or number */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The offset values for back references < 10 are in a separate vector
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    because otherwise they would use more than two parsed pattern elements on
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    64-bit systems. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF) != 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto ISNOTFIXED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group = META_DATA(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (group < 10)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      offset = cb->small_ref_offset[group];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      goto RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* For groups >= 10 - picking up group twice does no harm. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* A true recursion implies not fixed length, but a subroutine call may
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    be OK. Back reference "recursions" are also failed. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group = META_DATA(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (group > cb->bracount)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      *errcodeptr = ERR15;  /* Non-existent subpattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (group == 0) goto ISNOTFIXED;  /* Local recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for (gptr = cb->parsed_pattern; *gptr != META_END; gptr++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (META_CODE(*gptr) == META_BIGVALUE) gptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        else if (*gptr == (META_CAPTURE | group)) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* We must start the search for the end of the group at the first meta code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    inside the group. Otherwise it will be treated as an enclosed group. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    gptrend = parsed_skip(gptr + 1, PSKIP_KET);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (gptrend == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (pptr > gptr && pptr < gptrend) goto ISNOTFIXED;  /* Local recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) if (r->groupptr == gptr) break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (r != NULL) goto ISNOTFIXED;   /* Mutual recursion */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    this_recurse.prev = recurses;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    this_recurse.groupptr = gptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* We do not need to know the position of the end of the group, that is,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    gptr is not used after the call to get_grouplength(). Setting the second
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    argument FALSE stops it scanning for the end when the length can be found
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in the cache. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    gptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    grouplength = get_grouplength(&gptr, FALSE, errcodeptr, lcptr, group,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      &this_recurse, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (grouplength < 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (*errcodeptr == 0) goto ISNOTFIXED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return -1;  /* Error already set */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    itemlength = grouplength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* A (DEFINE) group is never obeyed inline and so it does not contribute to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    the length of this branch. Skip from the following item to the next
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    unpaired ket. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_DEFINE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr = parsed_skip(pptr + 1, PSKIP_KET);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Check other nested groups - advance past the initial data for each type
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    and then seek a fixed length with get_grouplength(). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 2 + SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto CHECK_GROUP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_ASSERT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto CHECK_GROUP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_VERSION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 4;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto CHECK_GROUP;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    group = META_DATA(*pptr);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ATOMIC:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_NOCAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    CHECK_GROUP:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    grouplength = get_grouplength(&pptr, TRUE, errcodeptr, lcptr, group,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      recurses, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (grouplength < 0) return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    itemlength = grouplength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Exact repetition is OK; variable repetition is not. A repetition of zero
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    must subtract the length that has already been added. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (pptr[1] == pptr[2])
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      switch(pptr[1])
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case 0:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        branchlength -= lastitemlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        case 1:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        itemlength = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        default:  /* Check for integer overflow */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (lastitemlength != 0 &&  /* Should not occur, but just in case */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            INT_MAX/lastitemlength < pptr[1] - 1)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          *errcodeptr = ERR87;  /* Integer overflow; lookbehind too big */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        itemlength = (pptr[1] - 1) * lastitemlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Fall through */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Any other item means this branch does not have a fixed length. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ISNOTFIXED:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errcodeptr = ERR25;   /* Not fixed length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Add the item length to the branchlength, checking for integer overflow and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for the branch length exceeding the limit. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (INT_MAX - branchlength < (int)itemlength ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      (branchlength += itemlength) > LOOKBEHIND_MAX)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errcodeptr = ERR87;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Save this item length for use if the next item is a quantifier. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lastitemlength = itemlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								EXIT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*pptrptr = pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return branchlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PARSED_SKIP_FAILED:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errcodeptr = ERR90;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return -1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*        Set lengths in a lookbehind             *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called for each lookbehind, to set the lengths in its
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								branches. An error occurs if any branch does not have a fixed length that is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								less than the maximum (65535). On exit, the pointer must be left on the final
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ket.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								The function also maintains the max_lookbehind value. Any lookbehind branch
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								that contains a nested lookbehind may actually look further back than the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								length of the branch. The additional amount is passed back from
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								get_branchlength() as an "extra" value.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptrptr     pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errcodeptr  pointer to error code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lcptr       pointer to loop counter
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb          pointer to compile block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:      TRUE if all is well
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								              FALSE otherwise, with error code and offset set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static BOOL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								set_lookbehind_lengths(uint32_t **pptrptr, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int branchlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *bptr = *pptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								READPLUSOFFSET(offset, bptr);  /* Offset for error messages */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*pptrptr += SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								do
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *pptrptr += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  branchlength = get_branchlength(pptrptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (branchlength < 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* The errorcode and offset may already be set from a nested lookbehind. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*errcodeptr == 0) *errcodeptr = ERR25;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (cb->erroroffset == PCRE2_UNSET) cb->erroroffset = offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (branchlength > cb->max_lookbehind) cb->max_lookbehind = branchlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *bptr |= branchlength;  /* branchlength never more than 65535 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  bptr = *pptrptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								while (*bptr == META_ALT);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return TRUE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*         Check parsed pattern lookbehinds       *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function is called at the end of parsing a pattern if any lookbehinds
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								were encountered. It scans the parsed pattern for them, calling
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								set_lookbehind_lengths() for each one. At the start, the errorcode is zero and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the error offset is marked unset. The enables the functions above not to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								override settings from deeper nestings.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								This function is called recursively from get_branchlength() for lookaheads in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								order to process any lookbehinds that they may contain. It stops when it hits a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								non-nested closing parenthesis in this case, returning a pointer to it.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pptr      points to where to start (start of pattern or start of lookahead)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  retptr    if not NULL, return the ket pointer here
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  recurses  chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb        points to the compile block
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  lcptr     points to loop counter
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:    0 on success, or an errorcode (cb->erroroffset will be set)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								static int
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								check_lookbehinds(uint32_t *pptr, uint32_t **retptr,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb, int *lcptr)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int errorcode = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int nestlevel = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb->erroroffset = PCRE2_UNSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (; *pptr != META_END; pptr++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (*pptr < META_END) continue;  /* Literal */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  switch (META_CODE(*pptr))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    return ERR70;  /* Unrecognized meta code */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ESCAPE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (*pptr - META_ESCAPE == ESC_P || *pptr - META_ESCAPE == ESC_p)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pptr += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_KET:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (--nestlevel < 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (retptr != NULL) *retptr = pptr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ATOMIC:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_ASSERT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEADNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_NOCAPTURE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SCRIPT_RUN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    nestlevel++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ACCEPT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ALT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_ASTERISK_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CIRCUMFLEX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_EMPTY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_END:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CLASS_NOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOLLAR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_DOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_FAIL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PLUS_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_QUERY_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RANGE_ESCAPED:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RANGE_LITERAL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BACKREF_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_RECURSE_BYNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_DEFINE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    nestlevel++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNAME:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_RNUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    nestlevel++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COND_VERSION:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    nestlevel++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_STRING:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3 + SIZEOFFSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_BIGVALUE:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_OPTIONS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_POSIX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_POSIX_NEG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_QUERY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MINMAX_PLUS:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 3;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_MARK:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_COMMIT_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_PRUNE_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_SKIP_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_THEN_ARG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    pptr += 1 + pptr[1];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (!set_lookbehind_lengths(&pptr, &errorcode, lcptr, recurses, cb))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return errorcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/*************************************************
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*     External function to compile a pattern     *
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*************************************************/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This function reads a regular expression in the form of a string and returns
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								a pointer to a block of store holding a compiled version of the expression.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Arguments:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  pattern       the regular expression
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  patlen        the length of the pattern, or PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  options       option bits
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorptr      pointer to errorcode
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  erroroffset   pointer to error offset
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ccontext      points to a compile context or is NULL
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								Returns:        pointer to compiled data block, or NULL on error,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								                with errorcode and erroroffset set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_compile(PCRE2_SPTR pattern, PCRE2_SIZE patlen, uint32_t options,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   int *errorptr, PCRE2_SIZE *erroroffset, pcre2_compile_context *ccontext)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL utf;                             /* Set TRUE for UTF mode */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL ucp;                             /* Set TRUE for UCP mode */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL has_lookbehind = FALSE;          /* Set TRUE if a lookbehind is found */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								BOOL zero_terminated;                 /* Set TRUE for zero-terminated pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_real_code *re = NULL;           /* What we will return */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compile_block cb;                     /* "Static" compile-time data */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								const uint8_t *tables;                /* Char tables base pointer */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *code;                    /* Current pointer in compiled code */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR codestart;                 /* Start of compiled code */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SPTR ptr;                       /* Current pointer in pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t *pptr;                       /* Current pointer in parsed pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE length = 1;                /* Allow for final END opcode */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE usedlength;                /* Actual length used */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE re_blocksize;              /* Size of memory block */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE big32count = 0;            /* 32-bit literals >= 0x80000000 */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE parsed_size_needed;        /* Needed for parsed pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags;    /* Type of first/req code unit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t firstcu, reqcu;              /* Value of first/req code unit */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t setflags = 0;                /* NL and BSR set flags */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t skipatstart;                 /* When checking (*UTF) etc */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t limit_heap  = UINT32_MAX;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t limit_match = UINT32_MAX;    /* Unset match limits */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t limit_depth = UINT32_MAX;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int newline = 0;                      /* Unset; can be set by the pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int bsr = 0;                          /* Unset; can be set by the pattern */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int errorcode = 0;                    /* Initialize to avoid compiler warn */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								int regexrc;                          /* Return from compile */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t i;                           /* Local loop counter */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Comments at the head of this file explain about these variables. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t stack_groupinfo[GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t stack_parsed_pattern[PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								named_group named_groups[NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The workspace is used in different ways in the different compiling phases.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								It needs to be 16-bit aligned for the preliminary parsing scan. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								uint32_t c16workspace[C16_WORK_SIZE];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_UCHAR *cworkspace = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)c16workspace;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* -------------- Check arguments and set up the pattern ----------------- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* There must be error code and offset pointers. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (errorptr == NULL || erroroffset == NULL) return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errorptr = ERR0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*erroroffset = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* There must be a pattern! */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (pattern == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorptr = ERR16;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* A NULL compile context means "use a default context" */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (ccontext == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ccontext = (pcre2_compile_context *)(&PRIV(default_compile_context));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF implies UTF */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF) != 0) options |= PCRE2_UTF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Check that all undefined public option bits are zero. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (ccontext->extra_options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorptr = ERR17;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) != 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ((options & ~PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     (ccontext->extra_options & ~PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS) != 0))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorptr = ERR92;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* A zero-terminated pattern is indicated by the special length value
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED. Check for an overlong pattern. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((zero_terminated = (patlen == PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED)))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  patlen = PRIV(strlen)(pattern);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (patlen > ccontext->max_pattern_length)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  *errorptr = ERR88;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  return NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* From here on, all returns from this function should end up going via the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								EXIT label. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* ------------ Initialize the "static" compile data -------------- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								tables = (ccontext->tables != NULL)? ccontext->tables : PRIV(default_tables);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.lcc = tables + lcc_offset;          /* Individual */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.fcc = tables + fcc_offset;          /*   character */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.cbits = tables + cbits_offset;      /*      tables */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.ctypes = tables + ctypes_offset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.assert_depth = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.bracount = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.cx = ccontext;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.dupnames = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.end_pattern = pattern + patlen;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.erroroffset = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.external_flags = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.external_options = options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.groupinfo = stack_groupinfo;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.had_recurse = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.lastcapture = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.max_lookbehind = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.name_entry_size = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.name_table = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.named_groups = named_groups;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.named_group_list_size = NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.names_found = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.open_caps = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.parens_depth = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.parsed_pattern = stack_parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.req_varyopt = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.start_code = cworkspace;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.start_pattern = pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.start_workspace = cworkspace;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.workspace_size = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Maximum back reference and backref bitmap. The bitmap records up to 31 back
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								references to help in deciding whether (.*) can be treated as anchored or not.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.top_backref = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.backref_map = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Escape sequences \1 to \9 are always back references, but as they are only
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								two characters long, only two elements can be used in the parsed_pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								vector. The first contains the reference, and we'd like to use the second to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								record the offset in the pattern, so that forward references to non-existent
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								groups can be diagnosed later with an offset. However, on 64-bit systems,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_SIZE won't fit. Instead, we have a vector of offsets for the first
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								occurrence of \1 to \9, indexed by the second parsed_pattern value. All other
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								references have enough space for the offset to be put into the parsed pattern.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*/
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								for (i = 0; i < 10; i++) cb.small_ref_offset[i] = PCRE2_UNSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* --------------- Start looking at the pattern --------------- */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Unless PCRE2_LITERAL is set, check for global one-time option settings at
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the start of the pattern, and remember the offset to the actual regex. With
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								valgrind support, make the terminator of a zero-terminated pattern
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								inaccessible. This catches bugs that would otherwise only show up for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								non-zero-terminated patterns. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (zero_terminated) VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(pattern + patlen, CU2BYTES(1));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ptr = pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								skipatstart = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  while (patlen - skipatstart >= 2 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         ptr[skipatstart] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								         ptr[skipatstart+1] == CHAR_ASTERISK)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    for (i = 0; i < sizeof(pso_list)/sizeof(pso); i++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      uint32_t c, pp;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      pso *p = pso_list + i;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (patlen - skipatstart - 2 >= p->length &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr + skipatstart + 2, (char *)(p->name),
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            p->length) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        skipatstart += p->length + 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        switch(p->type)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PSO_OPT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          cb.external_options |= p->value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PSO_FLG:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          setflags |= p->value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PSO_NL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          newline = p->value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          setflags |= PCRE2_NL_SET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PSO_BSR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          bsr = p->value;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          setflags |= PCRE2_BSR_SET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PSO_LIMM:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PSO_LIMD:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          case PSO_LIMH:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          c = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          pp = skipatstart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[pp]))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR60;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr += pp;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[pp]))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            if (c > UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break;   /* Integer overflow */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            c = c*10 + (ptr[pp++] - CHAR_0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (ptr[pp++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            errorcode = ERR60;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            ptr += pp;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (p->type == PSO_LIMH) limit_heap = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else if (p->type == PSO_LIMM) limit_match = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								            else limit_depth = c;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          skipatstart += pp - skipatstart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        break;   /* Out of the table scan loop */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (i >= sizeof(pso_list)/sizeof(pso)) break;   /* Out of pso loop */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* End of pattern-start options; advance to start of real regex. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ptr += skipatstart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Can't support UTF or UCP if PCRE2 was built without Unicode support. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifndef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((cb.external_options & (PCRE2_UTF|PCRE2_UCP)) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = ERR32;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Check UTF. We have the original options in 'options', with that value as
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								modified by (*UTF) etc in cb->external_options. The extra option
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES is not permitted in UTF-16 mode because the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								surrogate code points cannot be represented in UTF-16. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								utf = (cb.external_options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (utf)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((options & PCRE2_NEVER_UTF) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    errorcode = ERR74;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((options & PCRE2_NO_UTF_CHECK) == 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       (errorcode = PRIV(valid_utf)(pattern, patlen, erroroffset)) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto HAD_ERROR;  /* Offset was set by valid_utf() */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((ccontext->extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    errorcode = ERR91;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Check UCP lockout. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ucp = (cb.external_options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (ucp && (cb.external_options & PCRE2_NEVER_UCP) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = ERR75;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Process the BSR setting. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (bsr == 0) bsr = ccontext->bsr_convention;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Process the newline setting. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (newline == 0) newline = ccontext->newline_convention;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.nltype = NLTYPE_FIXED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								switch(newline)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  case PCRE2_NEWLINE_CR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nllen = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nl[0] = CHAR_CR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  case PCRE2_NEWLINE_LF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nllen = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nl[0] = CHAR_NL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  case PCRE2_NEWLINE_NUL:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nllen = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nl[0] = CHAR_NUL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  case PCRE2_NEWLINE_CRLF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nllen = 2;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nl[0] = CHAR_CR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nl[1] = CHAR_NL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  case PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANY:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nltype = NLTYPE_ANY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  case PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.nltype = NLTYPE_ANYCRLF;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  default:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = ERR56;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Pre-scan the pattern to do two things: (1) Discover the named groups and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								their numerical equivalents, so that this information is always available for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the remaining processing. (2) At the same time, parse the pattern and put a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								processed version into the parsed_pattern vector. This has escapes interpreted
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								and comments removed (amongst other things).
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								In all but one case, when PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT is not set, the number of unsigned
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								32-bit ints in the parsed pattern is bounded by the length of the pattern plus
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								one (for the terminator) plus four if PCRE2_EXTRA_WORD or PCRE2_EXTRA_LINE is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								set. The exceptional case is when running in 32-bit, non-UTF mode, when literal
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								characters greater than META_END (0x80000000) have to be coded as two units. In
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								this case, therefore, we scan the pattern to check for such values. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (!utf)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_SPTR p;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for (p = ptr; p < cb.end_pattern; p++) if (*p >= META_END) big32count++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Ensure that the parsed pattern buffer is big enough. When PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is set we have to assume a numerical callout (4 elements) for each character
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								plus one at the end. This is overkill, but memory is plentiful these days. For
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								many smaller patterns the vector on the stack (which was set up above) can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								used. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								parsed_size_needed = patlen - skipatstart + big32count;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((ccontext->extra_options &
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     (PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD|PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE)) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_size_needed += 4;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  parsed_size_needed = (parsed_size_needed + 1) * 5;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (parsed_size_needed >= PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  uint32_t *heap_parsed_pattern = ccontext->memctl.malloc(
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (parsed_size_needed + 1) * sizeof(uint32_t), ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (heap_parsed_pattern == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    *errorptr = ERR21;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.parsed_pattern = heap_parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.parsed_pattern_end = cb.parsed_pattern + parsed_size_needed + 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Do the parsing scan. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								errorcode = parse_regex(ptr, cb.external_options, &has_lookbehind, &cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Workspace is needed to remember information about numbered groups: whether a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								group can match an empty string and what its fixed length is. This is done to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								avoid the possibility of recursive references causing very long compile times
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								when checking these features. Unnumbered groups do not have this exposure since
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								they cannot be referenced. We use an indexed vector for this purpose. If there
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								are sufficiently few groups, the default vector on the stack, as set up above,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								can be used. Otherwise we have to get/free a special vector. The vector must be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								initialized to zero. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (cb.bracount >= GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  cb.groupinfo = ccontext->memctl.malloc(
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    (cb.bracount + 1)*sizeof(uint32_t), ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (cb.groupinfo == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    errorcode = ERR21;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    cb.erroroffset = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memset(cb.groupinfo, 0, (cb.bracount + 1) * sizeof(uint32_t));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If there were any lookbehinds, scan the parsed pattern to figure out their
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								lengths. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (has_lookbehind)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int loopcount = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = check_lookbehinds(cb.parsed_pattern, NULL, NULL, &cb, &loopcount);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* For debugging, there is a function that shows the parsed data vector. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								fprintf(stderr, "+++ Pre-scan complete:\n");
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								show_parsed(&cb);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* For debugging capturing information this code can be enabled. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_CAPTURES
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  named_group *ng = cb.named_groups;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  fprintf(stderr, "+++Captures: %d\n", cb.bracount);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for (i = 0; i < cb.names_found; i++, ng++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    fprintf(stderr, "+++%3d %.*s\n", ng->number, ng->length, ng->name);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Pretend to compile the pattern while actually just accumulating the amount
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								of memory required in the 'length' variable. This behaviour is triggered by
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								passing a non-NULL final argument to compile_regex(). We pass a block of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								workspace (cworkspace) for it to compile parts of the pattern into; the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compiled code is discarded when it is no longer needed, so hopefully this
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								workspace will never overflow, though there is a test for its doing so.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								On error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								result of the function. The initial options have been put into the cb block,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								but we still have to pass a separate options variable (the first argument)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								because the options may change as the pattern is processed. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.erroroffset = patlen;   /* For any subsequent errors that do not set it */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pptr = cb.parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								code = cworkspace;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*code = OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								(void)compile_regex(cb.external_options, &code, &pptr, &errorcode, 0, &firstcu,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								   &firstcuflags, &reqcu, &reqcuflags, NULL, &cb, &length);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR;  /* Offset is in cb.erroroffset */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* This should be caught in compile_regex(), but just in case... */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (length > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = ERR20;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Compute the size of, and then get and initialize, the data block for storing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the compiled pattern and names table. Integer overflow should no longer be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								possible because nowadays we limit the maximum value of cb.names_found and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.name_entry_size. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re_blocksize = sizeof(pcre2_real_code) +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  CU2BYTES(length +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  (PCRE2_SIZE)cb.names_found * (PCRE2_SIZE)cb.name_entry_size);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re = (pcre2_real_code *)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ccontext->memctl.malloc(re_blocksize, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (re == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  errorcode = ERR21;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The compiler may put padding at the end of the pcre2_real_code structure in
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								order to round it up to a multiple of 4 or 8 bytes. This means that when a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compiled pattern is copied (for example, when serialized) undefined bytes are
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								read, and this annoys debuggers such as valgrind. To avoid this, we explicitly
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								write to the last 8 bytes of the structure before setting the fields. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memset((char *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code) - 8, 0, 8);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->memctl = ccontext->memctl;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->tables = tables;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->executable_jit = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memset(re->start_bitmap, 0, 32 * sizeof(uint8_t));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->blocksize = re_blocksize;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->magic_number = MAGIC_NUMBER;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->compile_options = options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->overall_options = cb.external_options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->extra_options = ccontext->extra_options;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->flags = PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH/8 | cb.external_flags | setflags;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->limit_heap = limit_heap;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->limit_match = limit_match;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->limit_depth = limit_depth;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->first_codeunit = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->last_codeunit = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->bsr_convention = bsr;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->newline_convention = newline;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->max_lookbehind = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->minlength = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->top_bracket = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->top_backref = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->name_entry_size = cb.name_entry_size;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->name_count = cb.names_found;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* The basic block is immediately followed by the name table, and the compiled
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								code follows after that. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								codestart = (PCRE2_SPTR)((uint8_t *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code)) +
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  re->name_entry_size * re->name_count;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Update the compile data block for the actual compile. The starting points of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the name/number translation table and of the code are passed around in the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								compile data block. The start/end pattern and initial options are already set
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								from the pre-compile phase, as is the name_entry_size field. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.parens_depth = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.assert_depth = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.lastcapture = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.name_table = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)((uint8_t *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.start_code = codestart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.req_varyopt = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.had_accept = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.had_pruneorskip = FALSE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								cb.open_caps = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* If any named groups were found, create the name/number table from the list
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								created in the pre-pass. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (cb.names_found > 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  named_group *ng = cb.named_groups;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for (i = 0; i < cb.names_found; i++, ng++)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    add_name_to_table(&cb, ng->name, ng->length, ng->number, i);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Set up a starting, non-extracting bracket, then compile the expression. On
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the result
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								of the function here. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pptr = cb.parsed_pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								code = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*code = OP_BRA;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								regexrc = compile_regex(re->overall_options, &code, &pptr, &errorcode, 0,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  &firstcu, &firstcuflags, &reqcu, &reqcuflags, NULL, &cb, NULL);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (regexrc < 0) re->flags |= PCRE2_MATCH_EMPTY;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->top_bracket = cb.bracount;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->top_backref = cb.top_backref;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->max_lookbehind = cb.max_lookbehind;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (cb.had_accept)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reqcu = 0;                     /* Must disable after (*ACCEPT) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  reqcuflags = REQ_NONE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  re->flags |= PCRE2_HASACCEPT;  /* Disables minimum length */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Fill in the final opcode and check for disastrous overflow. If no overflow,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								but the estimated length exceeds the really used length, adjust the value of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re->blocksize, and if valgrind support is configured, mark the extra allocated
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								memory as unaddressable, so that any out-of-bound reads can be detected. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*code++ = OP_END;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								usedlength = code - codestart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (usedlength > length) errorcode = ERR23; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  re->blocksize -= CU2BYTES(length - usedlength);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(code, CU2BYTES(length - usedlength));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Scan the pattern for recursion/subroutine calls and convert the group
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								numbers into offsets. Maintain a small cache so that repeated groups containing
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								recursions are efficiently handled. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#define RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (errorcode == 0 && cb.had_recurse)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_UCHAR *rcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_SPTR rgroup;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  unsigned int ccount = 0;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int start = RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  recurse_cache rc[RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE];
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  for (rcode = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)find_recurse(codestart, utf);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       rcode != NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								       rcode = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)find_recurse(rcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    int p, groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    groupnumber = (int)GET(rcode, 1);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if (groupnumber == 0) rgroup = codestart; else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      PCRE2_SPTR search_from = codestart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      rgroup = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for (i = 0, p = start; i < ccount; i++, p = (p + 1) & 7)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (groupnumber == rc[p].groupnumber)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          rgroup = rc[p].group;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /* Group n+1 must always start to the right of group n, so we can save
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        search time below when the new group number is greater than any of the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        previously found groups. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (groupnumber > rc[p].groupnumber) search_from = rc[p].group;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (rgroup == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        rgroup = PRIV(find_bracket)(search_from, utf, groupnumber);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (rgroup == NULL)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          errorcode = ERR53;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          break;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (--start < 0) start = RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE - 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        rc[start].groupnumber = groupnumber;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        rc[start].group = rgroup;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (ccount < RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE) ccount++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    PUT(rcode, 1, rgroup - codestart);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* In rare debugging situations we sometimes need to look at the compiled code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								at this stage. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef DEBUG_CALL_PRINTINT
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_printint(re, stderr, TRUE);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								fprintf(stderr, "Length=%lu Used=%lu\n", length, usedlength);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Unless disabled, check whether any single character iterators can be
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								auto-possessified. The function overwrites the appropriate opcode values, so
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the type of the pointer must be cast. NOTE: the intermediate variable "temp" is
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								used in this code because at least one compiler gives a warning about loss of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								"const" attribute if the cast (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart is used directly in the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								function call. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (errorcode == 0 && (re->overall_options & PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  PCRE2_UCHAR *temp = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (PRIV(auto_possessify)(temp, &cb) != 0) errorcode = ERR80;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Failed to compile, or error while post-processing. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Successful compile. If the anchored option was not passed, set it if
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								we can determine that the pattern is anchored by virtue of ^ characters or \A
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								or anything else, such as starting with non-atomic .* when DOTALL is set and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								there are no occurrences of *PRUNE or *SKIP (though there is an option to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								disable this case). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								     is_anchored(codestart, 0, &cb, 0, FALSE))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  re->overall_options |= PCRE2_ANCHORED;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Set up the first code unit or startline flag, the required code unit, and
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								then study the pattern. This code need not be obeyed if PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								is set, as the data it would create will not be used. Note that a first code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unit (but not the startline flag) is useful for anchored patterns because it
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								can still give a quick "no match" and also avoid searching for a last code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								unit. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE) == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  int minminlength = 0;  /* For minimal minlength from first/required CU */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If we do not have a first code unit, see if there is one that is asserted
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  (these are not saved during the compile because they can cause conflicts with
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  actual literals that follow). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    firstcu = find_firstassertedcu(codestart, &firstcuflags, 0);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Save the data for a first code unit. The existence of one means the
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  minimum length must be at least 1. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (firstcuflags < REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    re->first_codeunit = firstcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    minminlength++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* Handle caseless first code units. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((firstcuflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if (firstcu < 128 || (!utf && !ucp && firstcu < 255))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (cb.fcc[firstcu] != firstcu) re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* The first code unit is > 128 in UTF or UCP mode, or > 255 otherwise.
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      In 8-bit UTF mode, codepoints in the range 128-255 are introductory code
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      points and cannot have another case, but if UCP is set they may do. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (ucp && !utf && UCD_OTHERCASE(firstcu) != firstcu)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if ((utf || ucp) && firstcu <= MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               UCD_OTHERCASE(firstcu) != firstcu)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* When there is no first code unit, for non-anchored patterns, see if we can
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  set the PCRE2_STARTLINE flag. This is helpful for multiline matches when all
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  branches start with ^ and also when all branches start with non-atomic .* for
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  non-DOTALL matches when *PRUNE and SKIP are not present. (There is an option
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  that disables this case.) */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  else if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								           is_startline(codestart, 0, &cb, 0, FALSE))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    re->flags |= PCRE2_STARTLINE;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Handle the "required code unit", if one is set. In the UTF case we can
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  increment the minimum minimum length only if we are sure this really is a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  different character and not a non-starting code unit of the first character,
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  because the minimum length count is in characters, not code units. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (reqcuflags < REQ_NONE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 ||   /* Not UTF */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE ||                 /* First not set */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (firstcu & 0xf800) != 0xd800 ||             /* First not surrogate */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (reqcu & 0xfc00) != 0xdc00)                 /* Req not low surrogate */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 ||   /* Not UTF */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE ||                 /* First not set */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (firstcu & 0x80) == 0 ||                    /* First is ASCII */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (reqcu & 0x80) == 0)                        /* Req is ASCII */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      minminlength++;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    /* In the case of an anchored pattern, set up the value only if it follows
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    a variable length item in the pattern. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 ||
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (reqcuflags & REQ_VARY) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      re->last_codeunit = reqcu;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTSET;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /* Handle caseless required code units as for first code units (above). */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      if ((reqcuflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        if (reqcu < 128 || (!utf && !ucp && reqcu < 255))
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if (cb.fcc[reqcu] != reqcu) re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								          }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if (ucp && !utf && UCD_OTHERCASE(reqcu) != reqcu)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#else
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      else if ((utf || ucp) && reqcu <= MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT &&
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								               UCD_OTHERCASE(reqcu) != reqcu)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif  /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* Study the compiled pattern to set up information such as a bitmap of
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  starting code units and a minimum matching length. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (PRIV(study)(re) != 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    errorcode = ERR31;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    goto HAD_CB_ERROR;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If study() set a bitmap of starting code units, it implies a minimum
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  length of at least one. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if ((re->flags & PCRE2_FIRSTMAPSET) != 0 && minminlength == 0)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								    minminlength = 1;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  /* If the minimum length set (or not set) by study() is less than the minimum
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  implied by required code units, override it. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  if (re->minlength < minminlength) re->minlength = minminlength;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }   /* End of start-of-match optimizations. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Control ends up here in all cases. When running under valgrind, make a
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pattern's terminating zero defined again. If memory was obtained for the parsed
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								version of the pattern, free it before returning. Also free the list of named
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								groups if a larger one had to be obtained, and likewise the group information
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								vector. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								EXIT:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (zero_terminated) VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_DEFINED(pattern + patlen, CU2BYTES(1));
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								#endif
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (cb.parsed_pattern != stack_parsed_pattern)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ccontext->memctl.free(cb.parsed_pattern, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (cb.named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ccontext->memctl.free((void *)cb.named_groups, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								if (cb.groupinfo != stack_groupinfo)
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ccontext->memctl.free((void *)cb.groupinfo, ccontext->memctl.memory_data);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								return re;    /* Will be NULL after an error */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* Errors discovered in parse_regex() set the offset value in the compile
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								block. Errors discovered before it is called must compute it from the ptr
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								value. After parse_regex() is called, the offset in the compile block is set to
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								the end of the pattern, but certain errors in compile_regex() may reset it if
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								an offset is available in the parsed pattern. */
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								HAD_CB_ERROR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								ptr = pattern + cb.erroroffset;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								HAD_EARLY_ERROR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*erroroffset = ptr - pattern;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								HAD_ERROR:
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								*errorptr = errorcode;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								pcre2_code_free(re);
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								re = NULL;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								goto EXIT;
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						||
| 
								 | 
							
								/* End of pcre2_compile.c */
							 |